summaryrefslogtreecommitdiff
path: root/old/7vcv310.txt
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
Diffstat (limited to 'old/7vcv310.txt')
-rw-r--r--old/7vcv310.txt7029
1 files changed, 7029 insertions, 0 deletions
diff --git a/old/7vcv310.txt b/old/7vcv310.txt
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6288c31
--- /dev/null
+++ b/old/7vcv310.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,7029 @@
+Project Gutenberg's Voyages of Samuel de Champlain V3, by Samuel de Champlain
+
+Copyright laws are changing all over the world. Be sure to check the
+copyright laws for your country before downloading or redistributing
+this or any other Project Gutenberg eBook.
+
+This header should be the first thing seen when viewing this Project
+Gutenberg file. Please do not remove it. Do not change or edit the
+header without written permission.
+
+Please read the "legal small print," and other information about the
+eBook and Project Gutenberg at the bottom of this file. Included is
+important information about your specific rights and restrictions in
+how the file may be used. You can also find out about how to make a
+donation to Project Gutenberg, and how to get involved.
+
+
+**Welcome To The World of Free Plain Vanilla Electronic Texts**
+
+**eBooks Readable By Both Humans and By Computers, Since 1971**
+
+*****These eBooks Were Prepared By Thousands of Volunteers!*****
+
+
+Title: Voyages of Samuel de Champlain V3
+
+Author: Samuel de Champlain
+
+Release Date: November, 2004 [EBook #6825]
+[Yes, we are more than one year ahead of schedule]
+[This file was first posted on January 28, 2003]
+
+Edition: 10
+
+Language: English
+
+Character set encoding: ASCII
+
+*** START OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK VOYAGES OF SAMUEL DE CHAMPLAIN V3 ***
+
+
+
+
+Produced by Karl Hagen, Juliet Sutherland, Charles Franks,
+and the Online Distributed Proofreading Team.
+This file was produced from images generously made available by
+the Canadian Institute for Historical Microreproductions.
+
+
+
+
+
+CHAMPLAIN'S VOYAGES.
+
+VOYAGES
+OF
+SAMUEL DE CHAMPLAIN.
+
+TRANSLATED FROM THE FRENCH
+BY CHARLES POMEROY OTIS, PH.D.
+
+WITH HISTORICAL ILLUSTRATIONS,
+AND A
+MEMOIR
+By THE REV. EDMUND F. SLAFTER, A.M.
+
+VOL. III.
+
+1611-1618
+
+HELIOTYPE COPIES OF TEN MAPS AND ILLUSTRATIONS.
+
+Editor:
+
+THE REV. EDMUND F. SLAFTER, A.M.
+
+
+
+
+PREFACE
+
+The present volume completes the work proposed by the Prince Society of a
+translation into English of the VOYAGES OF CHAMPLAIN. It includes the
+journals issued in 1604, 1613, and 1619, and covers fifteen years of his
+residence and explorations in New France.
+
+At a later period, in 1632, Champlain published, in a single volume, an
+abridgment of the issues above mentioned, containing likewise a
+continuation of his journal down to 1631. This continuation covers thirteen
+additional years. But it is to be observed that the events recorded in the
+journal of these later years are immediately connected with the progress
+and local interests of the French colony at Quebec. This last work of the
+great explorer is of primary importance and value as constituting original
+material for the early history of Canada, and a translation of it into
+English would doubtless be highly appreciated by the local historian. A
+complete narrative of these events, however, together with a large amount
+amount of interesting matter relating to the career of Champlain derived
+from other sources, is given in the Memoir contained in the first volume of
+this work.
+
+This English translation contains not only the complete narratives of all
+the personal explorations made by Champlain into the then unbroken forests
+of America, but the whole of his minute, ample, and invaluable descriptions
+of the character and habits, mental, moral, and physical of the various
+savage tribes with which he came in contact. It will furnish, therefore, to
+the student of history and the student of ethnology most valuable
+information, unsurpassed in richness and extent, and which cannot be
+obtained from any other source. To aid one or both of these two classes in
+their investigations, the work was undertaken and has now been completed.
+
+E. F. S.
+
+BOSTON, 91 BOYLSTON STREET,
+April 5, 1882.
+
+
+
+
+TABLE OF CONTENTS.
+
+PREFACE
+VOYAGE OF CHAMPLAIN IN 1611
+DEDICATION TO HENRI DE BOURBON, PRINCE DE CONDE
+VOYAGE MADE IN 1613
+DEDICATION TO THE KING
+CHAMPLAIN'S PREFACE
+EXTRACT FROM THE LICENSE OF THE KING
+VOYAGE MADE IN 1615
+VOYAGE MADE IN 1618
+EXPLANATION OF TWO GEOGRAPHICAL MAPS OF NEW FRANCE
+
+ILLUSTRATIONS.
+
+LE GRAND SAULT ST. LOUIS
+DRESS OF THE SAVAGES
+FORT OF THE IROQUOIS
+DEER TRAP
+DRESS OF THE SAVAGES
+CHAMPLAIN'S LARGE MAP OF NEW FRANCE, 1612
+CHAMPLAIN'S SMALL MAP OF NEW FRANCE, 1613
+
+INDEX
+
+
+
+
+THE VOYAGES
+
+OF SIEUR DE CHAMPLAIN,
+
+Of Saintonge, Captain in ordinary to the
+King in the Marine;
+
+OR,
+
+_A MOST FAITHFUL JOURNAL OF OBSERVATIONS made in the, exploration of New
+France, describing not only the countries, coasts, rivers, ports, and
+harbors, with their latitudes, and the various deflections of the Magnetic
+Needle, but likewise the religious belief of the inhabitants, their
+superstitions, mode of life and warfare; furnished with numerous
+illustrations_.
+
+Together with two geographical maps: the first for the purposes of
+navigation, adapted to the compass as used by mariners, which, deflects to
+the north-east; the other in its true meridian, with longitudes and
+latitudes, to which is added the Voyage to the Strait north of Labrador,
+from the 53d to the 63d degree of latitude, discovered in 1612 by the
+English when they were searching for a northerly course to China.
+
+PARIS.
+
+JEAN BERJON, Rue St Jean de Beauvais, at the Flying Horse, and at his store
+in the Palace, at the gallery of the Prisoners.
+
+M. DC. XIII.
+
+_WITH AUTHORITY OF THE KING_.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER I.
+
+DEPARTURE FROM FRANCE TO RETURN TO NEW FRANCE.--THE DANGERS AND OTHER
+EVENTS WHICH OCCURRED UP TO THE TIME OF ARRIVAL AT THE SETTLEMENT.
+
+We set out from Honfleur on the first day of March. The wind was favorable
+until the eighth, when we were opposed by a wind south-southwest and
+west-northwest, driving us as far as latitude 42 deg., without our being able
+to make a southing, so as to sail straight forward on our course.
+Accordingly after encountering several heavy winds, and being kept back by
+bad weather, we nevertheless, through great difficulty and hardship, and by
+sailing on different tacks, succeeded in arriving within eighty leagues of
+the Grand Bank, where the fresh fishery is carried on. Here we encountered
+ice thirty or forty fathoms high, or more, which led us to consider what
+course we ought to take, fearing that we might fall in with more during the
+night, or that the wind changing would drive us on to it. We also concluded
+that this would not be the last, since we had set out from France too early
+in the season. We sailed accordingly during that day with short sail, as
+near the wind as we could. When night came, the fog arose so thick and
+obscure that we could scarcely see the ship's length. About eleven o'clock
+at night, more ice was seen, which alarmed us. But through the energy of
+the sailors we avoided it. Supposing that we had passed all danger, we met
+with still more ice, which the sailors saw ahead of our vessel, but not
+until we were almost upon it. When all had committed themselves to God,
+having given up all hope of avoiding collision with this ice, which was
+already under our bowsprit, they cried to the helmsman to bear off; and
+this ice which was very extensive drove in such a manner that it passed by
+without striking our vessel, which stopped short, and remained as still as
+if it had never moved, to let it pass. Although the danger was over, our
+blood was not so quickly cooled, so great had been our fear, and we praised
+God for delivering us from so imminent a peril. This experience being over,
+we passed the same night two or three other masses of ice, not less
+dangerous than the former ones. There was at the same time a dripping fog,
+and it was so cold that we could scarcely get warm. The next day we met
+several other large and very high masses of ice, which, in the distance,
+looked like islands. We, however, avoided them all, and reached the Grand
+Bank, where we were detained by bad weather for the space of six days. The
+wind growing a little milder, and very favorable, we left the banks in
+latitude 44 deg. 30', which was the farthest south we could go. After sailing
+some sixty leagues west-northwest, we saw a vessel coming down to make us
+out, but which afterwards wore off to the east-northeast, to avoid a large
+bank of ice, which covered the entire extent of our line of vision.
+Concluding that there was a passage through the middle of this great floe,
+which was divided into two parts, we entered, in pursuance of our course,
+between the two, and sailed some ten leagues without seeing anything,
+contrary to our conjecture of a fine passage through, until evening, when
+we found the floe closed up. This gave us much anxiety as to what was to be
+done, the night being at hand and there being no moon, which deprived us of
+all means of returning to the point whence we had come. Yet, after due
+deliberation, it was resolved to try to find again the entrance by which we
+had come, which we set about accomplishing. But the night coming on with
+fog, rain, snow, and a wind so violent that we could scarcely carry our
+mainsail, every trace of our way was lost. For, as we were expecting to
+avoid the ice so as to pass out, the wind had already closed up the
+passage, so that we were obliged to return to the other tack. We were
+unable to remain longer than a quarter of an hour on one tack before taking
+another, in order to avoid the numerous masses of ice drifting about on all
+sides. We thought more than twenty times that we should never escape with
+our lives. The entire night was spent amid difficulties and hardships.
+Never was the watch better kept, for nobody wished to rest, but to strive
+to escape from the ice and danger. The cold was so great, that all the
+ropes of the vessel were so frozen and covered with large icicles that the
+men could not work her nor stick to the deck. Thus we ran, on this tack and
+that, awaiting with hope the daylight. But when it came, attended by a fog,
+and we saw that our labor and hardship could not avail us anything, we
+determined to go to a mass of ice, where we should be sheltered from the
+violent wind which was blowing; to haul everything down, and allow
+ourselves to be driven along with the ice, so that when at some distance
+from the rest of the ice we could make sail again, and go back to the
+above-mentioned bank and manage as before, until the fog should pass away,
+when we might go out as quickly as possible. Thus we continued the entire
+day until the morning of the next day, when we set sail, now on this tack
+now on that, finding ourselves everywhere enclosed amid large floes of ice,
+as if in lakes on the mainland. At evening we sighted a vessel on the other
+side of one of these banks of ice, which, I am sure, was in no less anxiety
+than ourselves. Thus we remained four or five days, exposed to these risks
+and extreme hardships, until one morning on looking out in all directions,
+although we could see no opening, yet in one place it seemed as if the ice
+was not thick, and that we could easily pass through. We got under weigh,
+and passed by a large number of _bourguignons_; that is, pieces of ice
+separated from the large banks by the violence of the winds. Having reached
+this bank of ice, the sailors proceeded to provide themselves with large
+oars and pieces of wood, in order to keep off the blocks of ice we met. In
+this way we passed this bank, but not without touching some pieces of ice,
+which did no good to our vessel, although they inflicted no essential
+damage. Being outside, we praised God for our deliverance. Continuing our
+course on the next day, we encountered other pieces, in which we became so
+involved that we found ourselves surrounded on all sides, except where we
+had entered. It was accordingly necessary to turn back, and endeavor to
+double the southern point. This we did not succeed in doing until the
+second day, passing by several small pieces of ice, which had been
+separated from the main bank. This latter was in latitude 44 deg. 30'. We
+sailed until the morning of the next day, towards the northwest, north-
+northwest, when we met another large ice bank, extending as far as we could
+see east and west. This, in the distance, seemed like land; for it was so
+level that it might properly be said to have been made so on purpose. It
+was more than eighteen feet high, extending twice as far under water. We
+calculated that we were only some fifteen leagues from Cape Breton, it
+being the 26th day of the month. These numerous encounters with ice
+troubled us greatly. We were also fearful that the passage between Capes
+Breton and Raye would be closed, and that we should be obliged to keep out
+to sea a long time before being able to enter. Unable to do anything else,
+we were obliged to run out to sea again some four or five leagues, in order
+to double another point of the above-mentioned grand ice bank, which
+continued on our west-southwest. After turning on the other tack to the
+northwest, in order to double this point, we sailed some seven leagues, and
+then steered to the north-northwest some three leagues, when we observed
+another ice bank. The night approached, and the fog came on so that we put
+to sea to pass the remainder of the night, purposing at daybreak to return
+and reconnoitre the last mentioned ice. On the twenty-seventh day of the
+month, we sighted land west-northwest of us, seeing no ice on the north-
+northeast. We approached nearer for the sake of a better observation, and
+found that it was Canseau. This led us to bear off to the north for Cape
+Breton Island; but we had scarcely sailed two leagues when we encountered
+an ice bank on the northeast. Night coming on, we were obliged to put out
+to sea until the next day, when we sailed northeast, and encountered more
+ice, bearing east, east-southeast from us, along which we coasted heading
+northeast and north for more than fifteen leagues. At last we were obliged
+to sail towards the west, greatly to our regret, inasmuch as we could find
+no passage, and should be obliged to withdraw and sail back on our track.
+Unfortunately for us we were overtaken by a calm, so that it seemed as if
+the swell of the sea would throw us upon the ice bank just mentioned, and
+we got ready to launch our little boat, to use in case of necessity. If we
+had taken refuge on the above-mentioned ice it would only have been to
+languish and die in misery. While we were deliberating whether to launch
+our boat, a fresh breeze arose to our great delight, and thus we escaped
+from the ice. After we had sailed two leagues, night came on, with a very
+thick fog, causing us to haul down our sail, as we could not see, and as
+there were several large pieces of ice in our way, which we were afraid of
+striking. Thus we remained the entire night until the next day, which was
+the twenty-ninth, when the fog increased to such an extent that we could
+scarcely see the length of the vessel. There was also very little wind. Yet
+we did not fail to set sail, in order to avoid the ice. But, although
+expecting to extricate ourselves, we found ourselves so involved in it that
+we could not tell on which side to tack. We were accordingly again
+compelled to lower sail, and drift until the ice should allow us to make
+sail. We made a hundred tacks on one side and the other, several times
+fearing that we were lost. The most self-possessed would have lost all
+judgment in such a juncture; even the greatest navigator in the world. What
+alarmed us still more was the short distance we could see, and the fact
+that the night was coming on, and that we could not make a shift of a
+quarter of a league without finding a bank or some ice, and a great deal of
+floating ice, the smallest piece of which would have been sufficient to
+cause the loss of any vessel whatever. Now, while we were still sailing
+along amid the ice, there arose so strong a wind that in a short time the
+fog broke away, affording us a view, and suddenly giving us a clear air and
+fair sun. Looking around about us, we found that we were shut up in a
+little lake, not so much as a league and a half in circuit. On the north we
+perceived the island of Cape Breton, nearly four leagues distant, and it
+seemed to us that the passage-way to Cape Breton was still closed. We also
+saw a small ice bank astern of our vessel, and the ocean beyond that, which
+led us to resolve to go beyond the bank, which was divided. This we
+succeeded in accomplishing without striking our vessel, putting out to sea
+for the night, and passing to the southeast of the ice. Thinking now that
+we could double this ice bank, we sailed east-northeast some fifteen
+leagues, perceiving only a little piece of ice. At night we hauled down the
+sail until the next day, when we perceived another ice bank to the north of
+us, extending as far as we could see. We had drifted to within nearly half
+a league of it, when we hoisted sail, continuing to coast along this ice in
+order to find the end of it. While sailing along, we sighted on the first
+day of May a vessel amid the ice, which, as well as ourselves, had found it
+difficult to escape from it. We backed our sails in order to await the
+former, which came full upon us, since we were desirous of ascertaining
+whether it had seen other ice. On its approach we saw that it was the son
+[1] of Sieur de Poutrincourt, on his way to visit his father at the
+settlement of Port Royal. He had left France three months before, not
+without much reluctance, I think, and still they were nearly a hundred and
+forty leagues from Port Royal, and well out of their true course. We told
+them we had sighted the islands of Canseau, much to their satisfaction, I
+think, as they had not as yet sighted any land, and were steering straight
+between Cape St. Lawrence and Cape Raye, in which direction they would not
+have found Port Royal, except by going overland. After a brief conference
+with each other we separated, each following his own course. The next day
+we sighted the islands of St. Pierre, finding no ice. Continuing our course
+we sighted on the following day, the third of the month, Cape Raye, also
+without finding ice. On the fourth we sighted the island of St. Paul, and
+Cape St. Lawrence, being some eight leagues north of the latter. The next
+day we sighted Gaspe. On the seventh we were opposed by a northwest wind,
+which drove us out of our course nearly thirty-five leagues, when the wind
+lulled, and was in our favor as far as Tadoussac, which we reached on the
+13th day of May.[2] Here we discharged a cannon to notify the savages, in
+order to obtain news from our settlement at Quebec. The country was still
+almost entirely covered with snow. There came out to us some canoes,
+informing us that one of our pataches had been in the harbor for a month,
+and that three vessels had arrived eight days before. We lowered our boat
+and visited these savages, who were in a very miserable condition, having
+only a few articles to barter to satisfy their immediate wants. Besides
+they desired to wait until several vessels should meet, so that there might
+be a better market for their merchandise. Therefore they are mistaken who
+expect to gain an advantage by coming first, for these people are very
+sagacious and cunning.
+
+On the 17th of the month I set out from Tadoussac for the great fall,[3]
+to meet the Algonquin savages and other tribes, who had promised the year
+before to go there with my man, whom I had sent to them, that I might learn
+from him what he might see during the winter. Those at this harbor who
+suspected where I was going, in accordance with the promises which I had
+made to the savages, as stated above, began to build several small barques,
+that they might follow me as soon as possible. And several, as I learned
+before setting out from France, had some ships and pataches fitted out in
+view of our voyage, hoping to return rich, as from a voyage to the Indies.
+
+Pont Grave remained at Tadoussac expecting, if he did nothing there, to
+take a patache and meet me at the fall. Between Tadoussac and Quebec our
+barque made much water, which obliged me to stop at Quebec and repair the
+leak. This was on the 21st day of May.
+
+ENDNOTES:
+
+1. This was Charles de Biencourt, Sieur de Saint Just. He was closely
+ associated with his father, Sieur de Poutrincourt, in his colony at Port
+ Royal. _Vide_ Vol. I. p. 122, note 77.
+
+2. They left Honfleur on the first day of March, and were thus seventy-four
+ days in reaching Tadoussac. The voyage was usually made in favorable
+ weather in thirty days.
+
+3. The Falls of St. Louis, near Montreal, now more commonly known as the La
+ Chine Rapids.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER II.
+
+LANDING AT QUEBEC TO REPAIR THE BARQUE.--DEPARTURE FROM QUEBEC FOR THE
+FALL, TO MEET THE SAVAGES, AND SEARCH OUT A PLACE APPROPRIATE FOR A
+SETTLEMENT.
+
+
+On going ashore I found Sieur du Parc, who had spent the winter at the
+settlement. He and all his companions were very well, and had not suffered
+any sickness. Game, both large and small, had been abundant during the
+entire winter, as they told me. I found there the Indian captain, named
+_Batiscan_, and some Algonquins, who said they were waiting for me, being
+unwilling to return to Tadoussac without seeing me. I proposed to them to
+take one of our company to the _Trois Rivieres_ to explore the place, but
+being unable to obtain anything from them this year I put it off until the
+next. Still I did not fail to inform myself particularly regarding the
+origin of the people living there, of which they told me with exactness. I
+asked them for one of their canoes, which they were unwilling to part with
+on any terms, because of their own need of it. For I had planned to send
+two or three men to explore the neighborhood of the Trois Rivieres, and
+ascertain what there was there. This, to my great regret, I was unable to
+accomplish, and postponed the project to the first opportunity that might
+present itself.
+
+Meanwhile I urged on the repairs to our barque. When it was ready, a young
+man from La Rochelle, named Tresart, asked me to permit him to accompany me
+to the above-mentioned fall. This I refused, replying that I had special
+plans of my own, and that I did not wish to conduct any one to my
+prejudice, adding that there were other companies than mine there, and that
+I did not care to open up a way and serve as guide, and that he could make
+the voyage well enough alone and without my help.
+
+The same day I set out from Quebec, and arrived at the great fall on the
+twenty-eighth of May. But I found none of the savages who had promised me
+to be there on this day. I entered at once a poor canoe, together with the
+savage I had taken to France and one of my own men. After examining the two
+shores, both in the woods and on the river bank, in order to find a spot
+favorable for the location of a settlement, and to get a place ready for
+building, I went some eight leagues by land along the great fall and
+through the woods, which are very open, as far as a lake, [4] whither our
+savage conducted me. Here I observed the country very carefully. But in all
+that I saw, I found no place more favorable than a little spot to which
+barques and shallops can easily ascend, with the help of a strong wind or
+by taking a winding course, in consequence of the strong current. But above
+this place, which we named _La Place Royale_, at the distance of a league
+from Mont Royal, there are a great many little rocks and shoals, which are
+very dangerous. Near Place Royale there is a little river, extending some
+distance into the interior, along the entire length of which there are more
+than sixty acres of land cleared up and like meadows, where grain can be
+sown and gardens made. Formerly savages tilled these lands, [5] but they
+abandoned them on account of their wars, in which they were constantly
+engaged. There is also a large number of other fine pastures, where any
+number of cattle can graze. There are also the various kinds of trees found
+in France, together with many vines, nut and plum trees, cherries,
+strawberries, and other kinds of good fruit. Among the rest there is a very
+excellent one, with a sweet taste like that of plantains, a fruit of the
+Indies, as white as snow, with a leaf resembling that of nettles, and which
+creeps up the trees and along the ground like ivy. [6] Fish are very
+abundant, including all the varieties we have in France, and many very good
+ones which we do not have. Game is also plenty, the birds being of various
+kinds. There are stags, hinds, does, caribous, [7] rabbits, lynxes, [8]
+bears, beavers, also other small animals, and all in such large numbers,
+that while we were at the fall we were abundantly supplied with them.
+
+After a careful examination, we found this place one of the finest on this
+river. I accordingly forthwith gave orders to cut down and clear up the
+woods in the Place Royale, [9] so as to level it and prepare it for
+building. The water can easily be made to flow around it, making of it a
+little island, so that a habitation can be formed as one may wish.
+
+There is a little island some twenty fathoms from Place Royale, about a
+hundred paces long, where a good and strong settlement might be made. There
+are also many meadows, containing very good and rich potter's clay, as well
+adapted for brick as for building purposes, and consequently a very useful
+article. I had a portion of it worked up, from which I made a wall four
+feet thick, three or four high, and ten fathoms long, to see how it would
+stand during the winter, when the freshets came down, although I thought
+the water would not reach up to it, the ground there being twelve feet
+above the river, which was very high. In the middle of the river there was
+an island about three-quarters of a league around, where a good and strong
+town could be built. This we named _Isle de Sainte Helene_. [10] This river
+at the fall is like a lake, containing two or three islands, and bordered
+by fine meadows.
+
+On the first day of June, Pont Grave arrived at the fall, having been
+unable to accomplish anything at Tadoussac. A numerous company attended and
+followed after him to share in the booty, without the hope of which they
+would have been far in the rear.
+
+Now, while awaiting the savages, I had two gardens made, one in the
+meadows, the other in the woods, which I had cleared up. On the 2d of June
+I sowed some seeds, all of which came up finely, and in a short time,
+attesting the good quality of the soil.
+
+We resolved to send Savignon, our savage, together with another, to meet
+his countrymen, so as to hasten their arrival. They hesitated about going
+in our canoe, of which they were distrustful, it being a very poor one.
+They set out on the 5th. The next day four or five barques arrived as an
+escort for us, since they could do nothing at Tadoussac.
+
+On the 7th I went to explore a little river, along which the savages
+sometimes go to war, and which flows into the fall of the river of the
+Iroquois. [11] It is very pleasant, with meadow land more than three
+leagues in circuit, and much arable land. It is distant a league from the
+great fall, and a league and a half from Place Royale.
+
+On the 9th our savage arrived. He had gone somewhat beyond the lake, which
+is ten leagues long, and which I had seen before. [12] But he met no one,
+and they were unable to go any farther, as their canoe gave out, which
+obliged them to return. They reported that after passing the fall they saw
+an island, where there was such a quantity of herons that the air was
+completely filled with them. There was a young man belonging to Sieur de
+Monts named Louis, who was very fond of the chase. Hearing this, he wished
+to go and satisfy his curiosity, earnestly entreating our savage to take
+him to the place. To this the savage consented, taking also a captain of
+the Montagnais, a very respectable person, whose name was _Outetoucos_. On
+the following morning Louis caused the two savages to be called, and went
+with them in a canoe to the island of the herons. This island is in the
+middle of the fall. [13] Here they captured as many herons and other birds
+as they wanted, and embarked again in their canoe. Outetoucos, contrary to
+the wish of the other savage, and against his remonstrances, desired to
+pass through a very dangerous place, where the water fell more than three
+feet, saying that he had formerly gone this way, which, however, was
+false. He had a long discussion in opposition to our savage, who wished to
+take him on the south side, along the mainland, [14] where they usually go.
+This, however, Outetoucos did not wish, saying that there was no danger.
+Our savage finding him obstinate yielded to his desire. But he insisted
+that at least a part of the birds in the canoe should be taken out, as it
+was overloaded, otherwise he said it would inevitably fill and be lost. But
+to this he would not consent, saying that it would be time enough when they
+found themselves in the presence of danger. They accordingly permitted
+themselves to be carried along by the current. But when they reached the
+precipice, they wanted to throw overboard their load in order to escape. It
+was now, however, too late, for they were completely in the power of the
+rapid water, and were straightway swallowed up in the whirlpools of the
+fall, which turned them round a thousand times. For a long time they clung
+to the boat. Finally the swiftness of the water wearied them so that this
+poor Louis, who could not swim at all, entirely lost his presence of mind,
+and, the canoe going down, he was obliged to abandon it. As it returned to
+the surface, the two others who kept holding on to it, saw Louis no more,
+and thus he died a sad death. [15] The two others continued to hold on to
+the canoe. When, however, they were out of danger, this Outetoucos, being
+naked and having confidence in his swimming powers, abandoned it in the
+expectation of reaching the shore, although the water still ran there with
+great rapidity. But he was drowned, for he had been so weakened and
+overcome by his efforts that it was impossible for him to save himself
+after abandoning the canoe. Our savage Savignon, understanding himself
+better, held firmly to the canoe until it reached an eddy, whither the
+current had carried it. Here he managed so well that, notwithstanding his
+suffering and weariness, he approached the shore gradually, when, after
+throwing the water out of the canoe, he returned in great fear that they
+would take vengeance upon him, as the savages do among themselves, and
+related to us this sad story, which caused us great sorrow.
+
+On the next day I went in another canoe to the fall, together with the
+savage and another member of our company, to see the place where they had
+met with their accident, and find, if possible, the remains. But when he
+showed me the spot, I was horrified at beholding such a terrible place, and
+astonished that the deceased should have been so lacking in judgment as to
+pass through such a fearful place, when they could have gone another way.
+For it is impossible to go along there, as there are seven or eight
+descents of water one after the other, the lowest three feet high, the
+seething and boiling of the water being fearful. A part of the fall was all
+white with foam, indicating the worst spot, the noise of which was like
+thunder, the air resounding with the echo of the cataracts. After viewing
+and carefully examining this place, and searching along the river bank for
+the dead bodies, another very light shallop having proceeded meanwhile on
+the other bank also, we returned without finding anything.
+
+ * * * * *
+
+CHAMPLAIN'S EXPLANATION OF THE ACCOMPANYING MAP.
+
+LE GRAND SAULT ST. LOUIS.
+
+A. Small place that I had cleared up.
+B. Small pond.
+C. Small islet, where I had a stone wall made.
+D. Small brook, where the barques are kept.
+E. Meadows where the savages stay when they come to this region.
+F. Mountains seen in the interior.
+G. Small pond.
+H. Mont Royal.
+I. Small brook.
+L. The fall.
+M. Place on the north side, where the savages transfer their canoes by
+ land.
+N. Spot where one of our men and a savage were drowned.
+O. Small rocky islet.
+P. Another islet where birds make their nests.
+Q. Heron island.
+R. Another island in the fall.
+S. Small islet
+T. Small round islet.
+V. Another islet half covered with water.
+X. Another islet, where there are many river birds.
+Y. Meadows.
+Z. Small river.
+2. Very large and fine islands.
+3. Places which are bare when the water is low, where there are great
+ eddies, as at the main fall.
+4. Meadows covered with water
+5. Very shallow places.
+6. Another little islet.
+7. Small rocks.
+8. Island St. Helene.
+9. Small island without trees.
+oo. Marshes connecting with the great fall.
+
+ENDNOTES:
+
+4. This journey of eight leagues would take them as far as the Lake of Two
+ Mountains.
+
+5. This little river is mentioned by Champlain in his Voyage of 1603,
+ Vol. I. p. 268. It is represented on early maps as formed by two small
+ streams, flowing, one from the north or northeastern, and the other from
+ the southern side of the mountain, in the rear of the city of Montreal,
+ which unite some distance before they reach the St. Lawrence, flowing
+ into that river at Point Callieres. These little brooks are laid down on
+ Champlain's local map, _Le Grand Sault St. Louis_, on Charlevoix's
+ _Carte de l'Isle de Montreal_, 1744, and on Bellin's _L'Isle de
+ Montreal_, 1764; but they have disappeared on modern maps, and probably
+ are either extinct or are lost in the sewerage of the city, of which
+ they have become a part. We have called the stream formed by these two
+ brooks, note 190, Vol. I., _Riviere St. Pierre_. On Potherie's map, the
+ only stream coming from the interior is so named. _Vide Histoire de
+ L'Amerique_ par M. de Bacqueville de la Potherie, 1722, p. 311. On a map
+ in Greig's _Hochelaga Depicta_, 1839, it is called St. Peter's River.
+ The same stream on Bouchette's map, 1830, is denominated Little River.
+ It seems not unlikely that a part of it was called, at one time, Riviere
+ St. Pierre, and another part Petite Riviere.
+
+ It is plain that on this stream was situated the sixty acres of cleared
+ land alluded to in the text as formerly occupied by the savages.
+
+ It will be remembered that seventy-six years anterior to this, in 1535,
+ Jacques Cartier discovered this place, which was then the seat of a
+ large and flourishing Indian town. It is to be regretted that Champlain
+ did not inform us more definitely as to the history of the former
+ occupants of the soil. Some important, and we think conclusive, reasons
+ have been assigned for supposing that they were a tribe of the Iroquois.
+ Among others may be mentioned the similarity in the construction of
+ their towns and houses or cabins, the identity of their language as
+ determined by a collation of the words found in Cartier's journal with
+ the language of the Iroquois; and to these may be added the traditions
+ obtained by missionaries and others, as cited by Laverdiere, to which we
+ must not, however, attach too much value. _Vide Laverdiere in loco_.
+ While it seems probable that the former occupants were of the Iroquois
+ family, it is impossible to determine whether on retiring they joined
+ the Five Nations in the State of New York, or merged themselves with the
+ Hurons, who were likewise of Iroquois origin.
+
+6. I am unable to identify this plant. Its climbing propensity and the
+ color of its fruit suggest _Rhus radicans_, but in other respects the
+ similarity fails.
+
+7. _Cerfs, Daims, Cheureuls, Caribous_. Champlain employs the names of the
+ different species of the Cerf family as used in Europe; but as our
+ species are different, this use of names creates some confusion. There
+ were in Canada, the moose, the caribou, the wapiti, and the common red
+ deer. Any enumeration by the early writers must include these, under
+ whatever names they may be described. One will be found applying a name
+ to a given species, while another will apply the same name to quite a
+ different species. Charlevoix mentions the orignal (moose) caribou, the
+ hart, and the roebuck. Under the name _hart_, he probably refers to the
+ wapiti, _elaphus Canadensis_, and _roe-buck_, to the common red deer,
+ _Cervus Virginianus_. _Vide Charlevoix's Letters to the Dutchess of
+ Lesdiguieres_, 1763, pp. 64-69, also Vol. I. of this work, p. 265.
+
+8. Lynxes, _Loups-seruiers_. The compound word _loup-cervier_ was
+ significant, and was applied originally to the animal of which the stag
+ was its natural prey, _qui attaque les cerfs_. In Europe it described
+ the lynx, a large powerful animal of the feline race, that might well
+ venture to attack the stag. But in Canada this species is not found.
+ What is known as the Canadian lynx, _Felis Canadensis_, is only a large
+ species of cat, which preys upon birds and the smaller quadrupeds.
+ Champlain probably gives it the name _loup-servier_ for the want of one
+ more appropriate. It is a little remarkable that he does not in this
+ list mention the American wolf, _Lupus occidentalis_, so common in every
+ part of Canada, and which he subsequently refers to as the animal
+ especially dreaded by the deer. _Vide postea_, pp. 139, 157.
+
+9. The site of Place Royale was on Point Callieres, so named in honor of
+ Chevalier Louis Hector de Callieres Bonnevue, governor of Montreal in
+ 1684.
+
+10. It seems most likely that the name of this island was suggested by the
+ marriage which Champlain had contracted with Helene Boulle, the year
+ before. This name had been given to several other places. _Vide_ Vol.
+ I. pp. 104, 105.
+
+11. _Vide_ Vol. I. p. 268, note 191. _Walker and Miles's Atlas_, map 186.
+
+12. The Lake of the Two Mountains. _Vide antea_, note 4.
+
+13. On Champlain's local map of the Falls of St. Louis, the letter Q is
+ wanting; but the expression, _ceste isle est au milieu du faut_, in the
+ middle of the fall, as suggested by Laverdiere, indicates that the
+ island designated by the letter R is Heron Island. _Vide postea_, R on
+ map at p. 18.
+
+14. _Grand Tibie_, so in the original. This is a typographical error for
+ _grand terre_. _Vide_ Champlain, 1632, Quebec ed., p. 842.
+
+15. The death of this young man may have suggested the name which was
+ afterward given to the fall. He was, however, it is reasonable to
+ suppose, hardly equal in sanctity of character to the Saint Louis of
+ the French. Hitherto it had been called _Le Grand Saut_. But soon after
+ this it began to be called _Grand Saut S. Louys_. _Vide postea_,
+ pp. 38, 51, 59.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER III.
+
+TWO HUNDRED SAVAGES RETURN THE FRENCHMAN WHO HAD BEEN ENTRUSTED TO THEM,
+AND RECEIVE THE SAVAGE WHO HAD COME BACK FROM FRANCE.--VARIOUS INTERVIEWS
+ON BOTH SIDES.
+
+
+On the thirteenth day of the month [16] two hundred Charioquois [17]
+savages, together with the captains Ochateguin, Iroquet, and Tregouaroti,
+brother of our savage, brought back my servant. [18] We were greatly
+pleased to see them. I went to meet them in a canoe with our savage. As
+they were approaching slowly and in order, our men prepared to salute them
+with a discharge of arquebuses, muskets, and small pieces. When they were
+near at hand, they all set to shouting together, and one of the chiefs gave
+orders that they should make their harangue, in which they greatly praised
+us, commending us as truthful, inasmuch as I had kept the promise to meet
+them at this fall. After they had made three more shouts, there was a
+discharge of musketry twice from thirteen barques or pataches that were
+there. This alarmed them so, that they begged me to assure them that there
+should be no more firing, saying that the greater part of them had never
+seen Christians, nor heard thunderings of that sort, and that they were
+afraid of its harming them, but that they were greatly pleased to see our
+savage in health, whom they supposed was dead, as had been reported by some
+Algonquins, who had heard so from the Montagnais. The savage commended the
+treatment I had shown him in France, and the remarkable objects he had
+seen, at which all wondered, and went away quietly to their cabins,
+expecting that on the next day I would show them the place where I wished
+to have them dwell. I saw also my servant, who was dressed in the costume
+of the savages, who commended the treatment he had received from them. He
+informed me of all he had seen and learned during the winter, from the
+savages.
+
+The next day I showed them a spot for their cabins, in regard to which the
+elders and principal ones consulted very privately. After their long
+consultation they sent for me alone and my servant, who had learned their
+language very well. They told him they desired a close alliance with me,
+and were sorry to see here all these shallops, and that our savage had told
+them he did not know them at all nor their intentions, and that it was
+clear that they were attracted only by their desire of gain and their
+avarice, and that when their assistance was needed they would refuse it,
+and would not act as I did in offering to go with my companions to their
+country and assist them, of all of which I had given them proofs in the
+past. They praised me for the treatment I had shown our savage, which was
+that of a brother, and had put them under such obligations of good will to
+me, that they said they would endeavor to comply with anything I might
+desire from them, but that they feared that the other boats would do them
+some harm. I assured them that they would not, and that we were all under
+one king, whom our savage had seen, and belonged to the same nation, though
+matters of business were confined to individuals, and that they had no
+occasion to fear, but might feel as much security as if they were in their
+own country. After considerable conversation, they made me a present of a
+hundred castors. I gave them in exchange other kinds of merchandise. They
+told me there were more than four hundred savages of their country who had
+purposed to come, but had been prevented by the following representations
+of an Iroquois prisoner, who had belonged to me, but had escaped to his own
+country. He had reported, they said, that I had given him his liberty and
+some merchandise, and that I purposed to go to the fall with six hundred
+Iroquois to meet the Algonquins and kill them all, adding that the fear
+aroused by this intelligence had alone prevented them from coming. I
+replied that the prisoner in question had escaped without my leave, that
+our savage knew very well how he went away, and that there was no thought
+of abandoning their alliance, as they had heard, since I had engaged in war
+with them, and sent my servant to their country to foster their friendship,
+which was still farther confirmed by my keeping my promise to them in so
+faithful a manner.
+
+They replied that, so far as they were concerned, they had never thought of
+this; that they were well aware that all this talk was far from the truth,
+and that if they had believed the contrary they would not have come, but
+that the others were afraid, never having seen a Frenchman except my
+servant. They told me also that three hundred Algonquins would come in five
+or six days, if we would wait for them, to unite with themselves in war
+against the Iroquois; that, however, they would return without doing so
+unless I went. I talked a great deal with them about the source of the
+great river and their country, and they gave me detailed information about
+their rivers, falls, lakes and lands, as also about the tribes living
+there, and what is to be found in the region. Four of them assured me that
+they had seen a sea at a great distance from their country, but that it was
+difficult to go there, not only on account of the wars, but of the
+intervening wilderness. They told me also that the winter before some
+savages had come from the direction of Florida, beyond the country of the
+Iroquois, who lived near our ocean, and were in alliance with these
+savages. In a word, they made me a very exact statement, indicating by
+drawings all the places where they had been, and taking pleasure in talking
+to me about them; and for my part I did not tire of listening to them, as
+they confirmed points in regard to which I had been before in doubt. After
+all this conversation was concluded, I told them that we would trade for
+the few articles they had, which was done the next day. Each one of the
+barques carried away its portion; we on our side had all the hardship and
+venture; the others, who had not troubled themselves about any
+explorations, had the booty, the only thing that urges them to activity, in
+which they employ no capital and venture nothing.
+
+The next day, after bartering what little they had, they made a barricade
+about their dwelling, partly in the direction of the wood, and partly in
+that of our pataches; and this they said they did for their security, in
+order to avoid the surprises of their enemies, which we took for the
+truth. On the coming night, they called our savage, who was sleeping on my
+patache, and my servant, who went to them. After a great deal of
+conversation, about midnight they had me called also. Entering their
+cabins, I found them all seated in council. They had me sit down near them,
+saying that when they met for the purpose of considering a matter, it was
+their custom to do so at night, that they might not be diverted by anything
+from attention to the subject in hand; that at night one thought only of
+listening, while during the day the thoughts were distracted by other
+objects.
+
+But in my opinion, confiding in me, they desired to tell me privately their
+purpose. Besides, they were afraid of the other pataches, as they
+subsequently gave me to understand. For they told me that they were uneasy
+at seeing so many Frenchmen, who were not especially united to one another,
+and that they had desired to see me alone; that some of them had been
+beaten; that they were as kindly disposed towards me as towards their own
+children, confiding so much in me that they would do whatever I told them
+to do, but that they greatly mistrusted the others; that if I returned I
+might take as many of their people as I wished, if it were under the
+guidance of a chief; and that they sent for me to assure me anew of their
+friendship, which would never be broken, and to express the hope that I
+might never be ill disposed towards them; and being aware that I had
+determined to visit their country, they said they would show it to me at
+the risk of their lives, giving me the assistance of a large number of men,
+who could go everywhere; and that in future we should expect such treatment
+from them as they had received from us.
+
+Straightway they brought fifty castors and four strings of beads, which
+they value as we do gold chains, saying that I should share these with my
+brother, referring to Pont Grave, we being present together; that these
+presents were sent by other captains, who had never seen me; that they
+desired to continue friends to me; that if any of the French wished to go
+with them, they should be greatly pleased to have them do so; and that they
+desired more than ever to establish a firm friendship. After much
+conversation with them, I proposed that inasmuch as they were desirous to
+have me visit their country, I would petition His Majesty to assist us to
+the extent of forty or fifty men, equipped with what was necessary for the
+journey, and that I would embark with them on condition that they would
+furnish us the necessary provisions for the journey, and that I would take
+presents for the chiefs of the country through which we should pass, when
+we would return to our settlement to spend the winter; that moreover, if I
+found their country favorable and fertile, we would make many settlements
+there, by which means we should have frequent intercourse with each other,
+living happily in the future in the fear of God, whom we would make known
+to them. They were well pleased with this proposition, and begged me to
+shake hands upon it, saying that they on their part would do all that was
+possible for its fulfilment; that, in regard to provisions, we should be as
+well supplied as they themselves, assuring me again that they would show me
+what I desired to see. Thereupon, I took leave of them at daybreak,
+thanking them for their willingness to carry out my wishes, and entreating
+them to continue to entertain the same feelings.
+
+On the next day, the 17th, they said that they were going castor-hunting,
+and that they would all return. On the following morning they finished
+bartering what little they had, when they embarked in their canoes, asking
+us not to take any steps towards taking down their dwellings, which we
+promised them. Then they separated from each other, pretending to go a
+hunting in different directions. They left our savage with me that we might
+have less distrust in them. But they had appointed themselves a rendezvous
+above the fall, where they knew well enough that we could not go with our
+barques. Meanwhile, we awaited them in accordance with what they had told
+us.
+
+The next day there came two savages, one Iroquet, the other the brother of
+our Savignon. They came to get the latter, and ask me in behalf of all
+their companions to go alone with my servant to where they were encamped,
+as they had something of importance to tell me, which they were unwilling
+to communicate to any Frenchmen. I promised them that I would go.
+
+The following day I gave some trifles to Savignon, who set out much
+pleased, giving me to understand that he was about to live a very irksome
+life in comparison with that which he had led in France. He expressed much
+regret at separation, but I was very glad to be relieved of the care of
+him. The two captains told me that on the morning of the next day they
+would send for me, which they did. I embarked, accompanied by my servant,
+with those who came. Having arrived at the fall, we went some eight leagues
+into the woods, where they were encamped on the shore of a lake, where I
+had been before.[19] They were much pleased at seeing me, and began to
+shout after their custom. Our Indian came out to meet me, and ask me to go
+to the cabin of his brother, where he at once had some meat and fish put on
+the fire for my entertainment. While I was there, a banquet was held, to
+which all the leading Indians were invited. I was not forgotten, although I
+had already eaten sufficiently; but, in order not to violate the custom of
+the country, I attended. After banqueting, they went into the woods to hold
+their council, and meanwhile I amused myself in looking at the country
+round about, which is very pleasant.
+
+Some time after they called me, in order to communicate to me what they had
+resolved upon. I proceeded to them accordingly with my servant. After I had
+seated myself by their side, they said they were very glad to see me, and
+to find that I had not failed to keep my word in what I had promised them;
+saying that they felt it an additional proof of my affection that I
+continued the alliance with them, and that before setting out they desired
+to take leave of me, as it would have been a very great disappointment to
+them to go away without seeing me, thinking that I would in that case have
+been ill disposed towards them. They said also that what had led them to
+say they were going a hunting, and build the barricade, was not the fear of
+their enemies nor the desire of hunting, but their fear of all the other
+pataches accompanying me, inasmuch as they had heard it said that on the
+night they sent for me they were all to be killed, and that I should not be
+able to protect them from the others who were much more numerous; so that
+in order to get away they made use of this ruse. But they said if there had
+been only our two pataches they would have stayed some days longer, and
+they begged that, when I returned with my companions, I would not bring any
+others. To this I replied that I did not bring these, but that they
+followed without my invitation; that in the future, however, I would come
+in another manner; at which explanation they were much pleased.
+
+And now they began again to repeat what they had promised me in regard to
+the exploration of the country, while I promised, with the help of God, to
+fulfil what I had told them. They besought me again to give them a man, and
+I replied that if there was any one among us who was willing to go, I
+should be well pleased.
+
+They told me there was a merchant, named Bouyer, commander of a patache,
+who had asked them to take a young man, which request, however, they had
+been unwilling to grant before ascertaining whether this was agreeable to
+me, as they did not know whether we were friends, since he had come in my
+company to trade with them; also that they were in no wise under any
+obligations to him, but that he had offered to make them large presents.
+
+I replied that we were in no wise enemies, and that they had often seen us
+conversing with each other; but that in regard to traffic each did what he
+could, and that the above-named Bouyer was perhaps desirous of sending this
+young man as I had sent mine, hoping for some return in the future, which I
+could also lay claim to from them; that, however, they must judge towards
+whom they had the greatest obligations, and from whom they were to expect
+the most.
+
+They said there was no comparison between the obligations in the two cases,
+not only in view of the help I had rendered them in their wars against
+their enemies, but also of the offer of my personal assistance in the
+future, in all of which they had found me faithful to the truth, adding
+that all depended on my pleasure. They said moreover that what made them
+speak of the matter was the presents he had offered them, and that, if this
+young man should go with them, it would not put them under such obligations
+to this Bouyer as they were under to me, and that it would have no
+influence upon the future, since they only took him on account of the
+presents from Bouyer.
+
+I replied that it was indifferent to me whether they took him or not, and
+in fact that if they took him for a small consideration I should be
+displeased at it, but if in return for valuable presents, I should be
+satisfied, provided he stayed with Iroquet; which they promised me. Then
+there was made on both sides a final statement of our agreements. They had
+with them one who had three times been made prisoner by the Iroquois, but
+had been successful in escaping. This one resolved to go, with nine others,
+to war, for the sake of revenge for the cruelties his enemies had caused
+him to suffer. All the captains begged me to dissuade him if possible,
+since he was very valiant, and they were afraid that, advancing boldly
+towards the enemy, and supported by a small force only, he would never
+return. To satisfy them I endeavored to do so, and urged all the reasons I
+could, which, however, availed little; for he, showing me a portion of his
+fingers cut off, also great cuts and burns on his body, as evidences of the
+manner they had tortured him, said that it was impossible for him to live
+without killing some of his enemies and having vengeance, and that his
+heart told him he must set out as soon as possible, as he did, firmly
+resolved to behave well.
+
+After concluding with them, I asked them to take me back in our patache. To
+accomplish this, they got ready eight canoes in order to pass the fall,
+stripping themselves naked, and directing me to go only in my shirt. For it
+often happens that some are lost in passing the fall. Consequently, they
+keep close to each other, so as to render assistance at once, if any canoe
+should happen to turn over. They said to me, if yours should unfortunately
+overturn, not knowing how to swim, you must not think of abandoning it, and
+must cling to the little pieces in the middle of it, for we can easily
+rescue you. I am sure that even the most self-possessed persons in the
+world, who have not seen this place nor passed it in little boats such as
+they have, could not do so without the greatest apprehension. But these
+people are so skilful in passing falls, that it is an easy matter for
+them. I passed with them, which I had never before done, nor any other
+Christian, except my above-mentioned servant. Then we reached our barques,
+where I lodged a large number of them, and had some conversation with the
+before-mentioned Bouyer in view of the fear he entertained that I should
+prevent his servant from going with the savages. They returned the next day
+with the young man, who proved expensive to his master who had expected, in
+my opinion, to recover the losses of his voyage, which were very
+considerable, like those of many others.
+
+One of our young men also determined to go with these savages, who are
+Charioquois, living at a distance of some one hundred and fifty leagues
+from the fall. He went with the brother of Savignon, one of the captains,
+who promised me to show him all that could be seen. Bouyer's man went with
+the above-mentioned Iroquet, an Algonquin, who lives some eighty leagues
+from the fall. Both went off well pleased and contented.
+
+After the departure of the savages, we awaited the three hundred others
+who, as had been told us, were to come, in accordance with the promise I
+had made them. Finding that they did not come, all the pataches determined
+to induce some Algonquin savages, who had come from Tadoussac, to go to
+meet them, in view of a reward that would be given them on their return,
+which was to be at the latest not over nine days from the time of their
+departure, so that we might know whether to expect them or not, and be able
+to return to Tadoussac. This they agreed to, and a canoe left with this
+purpose.
+
+On the fifth of July a canoe arrived from the Algonquins, who were to come
+to the number of three hundred. From it we learned that the canoe which had
+set out from us had arrived in their country, and that their companions,
+wearied by their journey, were resting, and that they would soon arrive, in
+fulfilment of the promise they had made; that at most they would not be
+more than eight days behindhand, but that there would be only twenty-four
+canoes, as one of their captains and many of their comrades had died of a
+fever that had broken out among them. They also said that they had sent
+many to the war, which had hindered their progress. We determined to wait
+for them.
+
+But finding that this period had elapsed without their arrival, Pont Grave
+set out from the fall on the eleventh of the month, to arrange some matters
+at Tadoussac, while I stayed to await the savages.
+
+The same day a patache arrived, bringing provisions for the numerous
+barques of which our party consisted. For our bread, wine, meat, and cider
+had given out some days before, obliging us to have recourse to fishing,
+the fine river water, and some radishes which grow in great abundance in
+the country; otherwise we should have been obliged to return. The same day
+an Algonquin canoe arrived, assuring us that on the next day the
+twenty-four canoes were to come, twelve of them prepared for war.
+
+On the twelfth the Algonquins arrived with some little merchandise. Before
+trafficking they made a present to a Montagnais Indian, the son of
+Anadabijou, [20] who had lately died, in order to mitigate his grief at the
+death of his father. Shortly after they resolved to make some presents to
+all the captains of the pataches. They gave to each of them ten castors,
+saying they were very sorry they had no more, but that the war, to which
+most of them were going, was the reason; they begged, however, that what
+they offered might be accepted in good part, saying that they were all
+friends to us, and to me, who was seated near them, more than to all the
+others, who were well disposed towards them only on account of their
+castors, and had not always assisted them like myself, whom they had never
+found double-tongued like the rest.
+
+I replied that all those whom they saw gathered together were their
+friends; that, in case an opportunity should present itself, they would not
+fail to do their duty; that we were all friends; that they should continue
+to be well disposed towards us; that we would make them presents in return
+for those they gave us; and that they should trade in peace. This they did,
+and carried away what they could.
+
+The next day they brought me privately forty castors, assuring me of their
+friendship, and that they were very glad of the conclusion which I had
+reached with the savages who had gone away, and that we should make a
+settlement at the fall, which I assured them we would do, making them a
+present in return.
+
+After everything had been arranged, they determined to go and obtain the
+body of Outetoucos, who was drowned at the fall, as we have before
+mentioned. They went to the spot where he had been buried, disinterred him
+and carried him to the island of St Helene, where they performed their
+usual ceremony, which is to sing and dance over the grave with festivities
+and banquets following. I asked them why they disinterred the body. They
+replied that if their enemies should find the grave they would do so, and
+divide the body into several pieces, which they would then hang to trees in
+order to offend them. For this reason they said that they transferred it to
+a place off from the road, and in the most secret manner possible.
+
+On the 15th there arrived fourteen canoes, the chief over which was named
+_Tecouehata_. Upon their arrival all the other savages took up arms and
+performed some circular evolutions. After going around and dancing to their
+satisfaction, the others who were in their canoes also began to dance,
+making various movements of the body. After finishing their singing, they
+went on shore with a small quantity of furs, and made presents similar to
+those of the others. These were reciprocated by some of equal value. The
+next day they trafficked in what little they had, and presented me
+personally with thirty castors, for which I made them an acknowledgment.
+They begged me to continue my good will to them, which I promised to do.
+They spoke with me very especially respecting certain explorations towards
+the north, which might prove advantageous; and said, in reference to them,
+that if any one of my company would like to go with them, they would show
+him what would please me, and would treat him as one of their own children.
+I promised to give them a young man, at which they were much pleased. When
+he took leave of me to go with them, I gave him a detailed memorandum of
+what he was to observe while with them. After they had bartered what little
+they had, they separated into three parties; one for the war, another for
+the great fall, another for a little river which flows into that of the
+great fall. Thus they set out on the 18th day of the month, on which day we
+also departed.
+
+The same day we made the thirty leagues from this fall to the Trois
+Rivieres. On the 19th we arrived at Quebec, which is also thirty leagues
+from the Trois Rivieres. I induced the most of those in each boat to stay
+at the settlement, when I had some repairs made and some rose-bushes set
+out. I had also some oak wood put on board to make trial of in France, not
+only for marine wainscoting, but also for windows. The next day, the 20th
+of July, I set out. On the 23d I arrived at Tadoussac, whence I resolved to
+return to France, in accordance with the advice of Pont Grave. After
+arranging matters relating to our settlement, according to the directions
+which Sieur de Monts had given me, I embarked in the vessel of Captain
+Tibaut, of La Rochelle, on the 11th of August. During our passage we had an
+abundance of fish, such as _orades_, mackerel, and _pilotes_, the latter
+similar to herrings, and found about certain planks covered with
+_pousle-pieds_, a kind of shell-fish attaching itself thereto, and growing
+there gradually. Sometimes the number of these little fish is so great that
+it is surprising to behold. We caught also some porpoises and other species
+of fish. The weather was favorable as far as Belle Isle, [21] where we were
+overtaken by fogs, which continued three or four days. The weather then
+becoming fair, we sighted Alvert, [22] and arrived at La Rochelle on the
+16th of September, 1611.
+
+ENDNOTES:
+
+16. June 13th.
+
+17. _Charioquois_. In the issue of 1632, p. 397, Champlain has _Sauuages
+ Hurons_. It is probable that Charioquois was only a chief of the
+ Hurons.
+
+18. This was the young man that had been sent to pass the winter with the
+ Indians, in exchange for the savage which had accompanied Champlain to
+ France. _Vide antea_, Vol. II. p. 246.
+
+19. This was doubtless on the Lake of Two Mountains.
+
+20. Champlain's orthography is here _Aronadabigeau. Vide_ Vol. I pp. 236,
+ 291.
+
+21. Belle Ile. An island on the coast of Brittany in France.
+
+22. Alvert, a village near Marennes, which they sighted as they approached
+ La Rochelle.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER IV.
+
+ARRIVAL AT LA ROCHELLE.--DISSOLUTION OF THE PARTNERSHIP BETWEEN SIEUR DE
+MONTS AND HIS ASSOCIATES, THE SIEURS COLIER AND LE GENDRE OF ROUEN.--
+JEALOUSY OF THE FRENCH IN REGARD TO THE NEW DISCOVERIES IN NEW FRANCE.
+
+
+Upon my arrival at La Rochelle I proceeded to visit Sieur de Monts, at Pons
+[23] in Saintonge, to inform him of all that had occurred during the
+expedition, and of the promise which the Ochateguins[24] and Algonquins had
+made me, on condition that we would assist them in their wars, as I had
+agreed. Sieur de Monts, after listening to it all, determined to go to the
+Court to arrange the matter. I started before him to go there also. But on
+the way I was unfortunately detained by the falling of a horse upon me,
+which came near killing me. This fall detained me some time; but as soon as
+I had sufficiently recovered from its effects I set out again to complete
+my journey and meet Sieur de Monts at Fontainebleau, who, upon his return
+to Paris, had a conference with his associates. The latter were unwilling
+to continue in the association, as there was no commission forbidding any
+others from going to the new discoveries and trading with the inhabitants
+of the country. Sieur de Monts, seeing this, bargained with them for what
+remained at the settlement at Quebec, in consideration of a sum of money
+which he gave them for their share. He sent also some men to take care of
+the settlement, in the expectation of obtaining a commission from His
+Majesty. But while he was engaged in the pursuit of this object some
+important matters demanded his attention, so that he was obliged to abandon
+it, and he left me the duty of taking the necessary steps for it. As I was
+about arranging the matter, the vessels arrived from New France with men
+from our settlement, those whom I had sent into the interior with the
+savages. They brought me very important information, saying that more than
+two hundred savages had come, expecting to find me at the great fall of
+St. Louis, where I had appointed a rendezvous, with the intention of
+assisting them according to their request. But, finding that I had not kept
+my promise, they were greatly displeased. Our men, however, made some
+apologies, which were accepted, and assured them that they would not fail
+to come the following year or never. The savages agreed to this on their
+part. But several others left the old trading-station of Tadoussac, and
+came to the fall with many small barques to see if they could engage in
+traffic with these people, whom they assured that I was dead, although our
+men stoutly declared the contrary. This shows how jealousy against
+meritorious objects gets possession of bad natures; and all they want is
+that men should expose themselves to a thousand dangers, to discover
+peoples and territories, that they themselves may have the profit and
+others the hardship. It is not reasonable that one should capture the lamb
+and another go off with the fleece. If they had been willing to participate
+in our discoveries, use their means, and risk their persons, they would
+have given evidence of their honor and nobleness, but on the contrary they
+show clearly that they are impelled by pure malice that they may enjoy the
+fruit of our labors equally with ourselves.
+
+On this subject, and to show how many persons strive to pervert
+praiseworthy enterprises, I will instance again the people of St. Malo and
+others, who say that the profit of these discoveries belongs to them, since
+Jacques Cartier, who first visited Canada and the islands of New Foundland,
+was from their city, as if that city had contributed to the expenses of
+these discoveries of Jacques Cartier, who went there by the order and at
+the expense of King Francis I, in the years 1534 and 1535 to discover these
+territories now called New France. If then Cartier made any discovery at
+the expense of His Majesty, all his subjects have the same rights and
+liberties in them as the people of St. Malo, who cannot prevent others who
+make farther discoveries at their own expense, as is shown in the case of
+the discoveries above described, from profiting by them in peace. Hence
+they ought not to claim any rights if they themselves make no
+contributions, and their reasons for doing so are weak and foolish.
+
+To prove more conclusively that they who maintain this position do so
+without any foundation, let us suppose that a Spaniard or other foreigner
+had discovered lands and wealth at the expense of the King of France. Could
+the Spaniards or other foreigners claim these discoveries and this wealth
+on the ground that the discoverer was a Spaniard or foreigner? No! There
+would be no sense in doing so, and they would always belong to France.
+Hence the people of St. Malo cannot make these claims for the reason which
+they give, that Cartier was a citizen of their city; and they can only take
+cognizance of the fact that he was a citizen of theirs, and render him
+accordingly the praise which is his due.
+
+Besides, Cartier in the voyage which he made never passed the great fall of
+St. Louis, and made no discoveries north or south of the river
+St. Lawrence. His narratives give no evidence of it, in which he speaks
+only of the river Saguenay, the Trois Rivieres and St. Croix, where he
+spent the winter in a fort near our settlement. Had he done so, he would
+not have failed to mention it, any more than what he has mentioned, which
+shows that he left all the upper part of the St. Lawrence, from Tadoussac
+to the great fall, being a territory difficult to explore, and that he was
+unwilling to expose himself or let his barques engage in the venture. So
+that what he did has borne no fruit until four years ago, when we made our
+settlement at Quebec, after which I ventured to pass the fall to help the
+savages in their wars, and fend among them men to make the acquaintance of
+the people, to learn their mode of living, and the character and extent of
+their territory. After devoting ourselves to labors which have been so
+successful, is it not just that we should enjoy their fruits, His Majesty
+not having contributed anything to aid those who have assumed the
+responsibilities of these undertakings up to the present time. I hope that
+God will at some time incline him to do so much for His service, his own
+glory and the welfare of his subjects, as to bring many new peoples to the
+knowledge of our faith, that they may at last enjoy the heavenly kingdom.
+
+
+NOTE.
+
+Champlain here introduces an explanation of his two geographical maps of
+New France, and likewise his method of determining a meridian line. For
+convenience of use the maps are placed at the end of this work, and for the
+same reason these explanations are carried forward to p. 219, in immediate
+proximity to the maps which they explain.--EDITOR.
+
+ENDNOTES:
+
+23. De Monts was governor of Pons, a town situated about ten miles south of
+ Saintes, in the present department of Lower Charente.
+
+24. _Ochateguins. Vide_ Vol III. Quebec ed. p 169. They were Hurons, and
+ Ochateguin is supposed to have been one of their chiefs. _Vide_ Vol
+ II. note 321.
+
+
+
+
+FOURTH VOYAGE
+OF
+SIEUR DE CHAMPLAIN,
+
+CAPTAIN IN ORDINARY TO THE KING IN THE MARINE, AND
+LIEUTENANT OF MONSEIGNEUR LE PRINCE DE
+CONDE IN NEW FRANCE,
+
+MADE IN THE YEAR 1613.
+
+
+To the very high, powerful, and excellent Henri de Bourbon, Prince de
+Conde, First Prince of the Blood, First Peer of France, Governor and
+Lieutenant of His Majesty in Guienne.
+
+_Monseigneur,
+
+The Honor that I have received from your Highness in being intrusted with
+the discovery of New France has inspired in me the desire to pursue with
+still greater pains and zeal than ever the search for the North Sea. With
+this object in view I have made a voyage during the past year, 1613,
+relying on a man whom I had sent there and who assured me he had seen it,
+as you will perceive in this brief narrative, which I venture to present to
+your Excellence, and in which are particularly described all the toils and
+sufferings I have had in the undertaking. But although I regret having lost
+this year so far as the main object is concerned, yet my expectation, as in
+the first voyage, of obtaining more definite information respecting the
+subject from the savages, has been fulfilled. They have told me about
+various lakes and rivers in the north, in view of which, aside from their
+assurance that they know of this sea, it seems to me easy to conclude from
+the maps that it cannot be far from the farthest discoveries I have
+hitherto made. Awaiting a favorable time and opportunity to prosecute my
+plans, and praying God to preserve you, most happy Prince, in all
+prosperity, wherein consists my highest wish for your greatness, I remain
+in the quality of
+
+ Your most humble and devoted servant,
+
+ SAMUEL DE CHAMPLAIN_.
+
+
+
+
+FOURTH VOYAGE
+OF
+SIEUR DE CHAMPLAIN,
+
+CAPTAIN IN ORDINARY TO THE KING IN THE MARINE, AND
+LIEUTENANT OF MONSEIGNEUR LE PRINCE DE
+CONDE IN NEW FRANCE,
+
+MADE IN THE YEAR 1613.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER I.
+
+WHAT LED ME TO SEEK FOR TERMS OF REGULATION.--A COMMISSION OBTAINED--
+OPPOSITIONS TO THE SAME.--PUBLICATION AT LAST IN ALL THE PORTS OF FRANCE.
+
+The desire which I have always had of making new discoveries in New France,
+for the good, profit, and glory of the French name, and at the same time to
+lead the poor natives to the knowledge of God, has led me to seek more and
+more for the greater facility of this undertaking, which can only be
+secured by means of good regulations. For, since individuals desire to
+gather the fruits of my labor without contributing to the expenses and
+great outlays requisite for the support of the settlements necessary to a
+successful result, this branch of trade is ruined by the greediness of
+gain, which is so great that it causes merchants to set out prematurely in
+order to arrive first in this country. By this means they not only become
+involved in the ice, but also in their own ruin, for, from trading with the
+savages in a secret manner and offering through rivalry with each other
+more merchandise than is necessary, they get the worst of the bargain.
+Thus, while purposing to deceive their associates, they generally deceive
+themselves.
+
+For this reason, when I returned to France on the 10th of September, 1611,
+I spoke to Sieur de Monts about the matter, who approved of my suggestions;
+but his engagements not allowing him to prosecute the matter at court, he
+left to me its whole management.
+
+I then drew up a statement, which I presented to President Jeannin, who,
+being a man desirous of seeing good undertakings prosper, commended my
+project, and encouraged me in its prosecution.
+
+But feeling assured that those who love to fish in troubled waters would be
+vexed at such regulations and seek means to thwart them, it seemed
+advisable to throw myself into the hands of some power whose authority
+would prevail over their jealousy.
+
+Now, knowing Monseigneur le Comte de Soissons[25] to be a prince devout and
+well disposed to all holy undertakings, I addressed myself to him through
+Sieur de Beaulieu, councillor, and almoner in ordinary to the King, and
+urged upon him the importance of the matter, setting forth the means of
+regulating it, the harm which disorder had heretofore produced, and the
+total ruin with which it was threatened, to the great dishonor of the
+French name, unless God should raise up some one who would reanimate it and
+give promise of securing for it some day the success which had hitherto
+been little anticipated. After he had been informed in regard to all the
+details of the scheme and seen the map of the country which I had made, he
+promised me, under the sanction of the King, to undertake the protectorate
+of the enterprise.
+
+I immediately after presented to His Majesty, and to the gentlemen of his
+Council, a petition accompanied by articles, to the end that it might
+please him to issue regulations for the undertaking, without which, as I
+have said, it would fail. Accordingly his Majesty gave the direction and
+control to the before-mentioned Count, who then honored me with the
+lieutenancy.
+
+Now as I was preparing to publish the commission [26] of the King in all
+the ports and harbors of France, there occurred the sickness and greatly
+lamented death of the Count, which postponed somewhat the undertaking. But
+his Majesty at once committed the direction to Monseigneur le Prince,[27]
+who proceeded in the execution of its duties, and, having in like manner
+honored me with the lieutenancy, [28] directed me to go on with the
+publication of the commission. But as soon as this was done, some marplots,
+who had no interest in the matter, importuned him to annul it, representing
+to him as they claimed the interests of all the merchants of France, who
+had no cause for complaint, since all were received into the association
+and could not therefore justly be aggrieved. Accordingly, their evil
+intention being recognized, they were dismissed, with permission only to
+enter into the association.
+
+During these altercations, it was impossible for me, as the time of my
+departure was very near at hand, to do anything for the habitation at
+Quebec, for repairing and enlarging which I desired to take out some
+workmen. It was accordingly necessary to go out this year without any
+farther organization. The passports of Monseigneur le Prince were made out
+for four vessels, which were already in readiness for the voyage, viz.
+three from Rouen and one from La Rochelle, on condition that each should
+furnish four men for my assistance, not only in my discoveries but in war,
+as I desired to keep the promise which I had made to the Ochataiguins [29]
+in the year 1611, to assist them in their wars at the time of my next
+voyage.
+
+As I was preparing to set out, I was informed that the Parliamentary Court
+of Rouen would not permit the publication of the commission of the King,
+because his Majesty had reserved to himself and his Council the sole
+cognizance of the differences which might arise in this matter; added to
+which was the fact that the merchants of St. Malo were also opposed to it.
+This greatly embarrassed me, and obliged me to make three journeys to
+Rouen, with orders of his Majesty, in consideration of which the Court
+desisted from their inhibition, and the assumptions of the opponents were
+overruled. The commission was then published in all the ports of Normandy.
+
+ENDNOTES:
+
+25. For a brief notice of the Count de Soissons, _vide_ Vol. I. note 74;
+ also note by Laverdiere, Quebec ed., p. 433.
+
+26. This Commission, dated October 15, 1612, will be found in Champlain's
+ issue of 1632. _Vide_ Quebec ed., p 887.
+
+27. Henry de Bourbon. _Vide_ Vol. I. p 113, note 75.
+
+28. Champlain was appointed lieutenant of the Prince de Conde on the 22d
+ day of November, 1612. _Vide_ issue of 1632, Quebec ed., p. 1072.
+
+29. Ochateguins, or Hurons.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER II.
+
+DEPARTURE FROM FRANCE.--WHAT TOOK PLACE UP TO OUR ARRIVAL AT THE FALLS.
+
+
+I set out from Rouen on the 5th of March for Honfleur, accompanied by Sieur
+L'Ange, to assist me in my explorations, and in war if occasion should
+require.
+
+On the next day, the 6th of the month, we embarked in the vessel of Sieur
+de Pont Grave, immediately setting sail, with a favorable wind.
+
+On the 10th of April we sighted the Grand Bank, where we several times
+tried for fish, but without success.
+
+On the 15th we had a violent gale, accompanied by rain and hail, which was
+followed by another, lasting forty-eight hours, and so violent as to cause
+the loss of several vessels on the island of Cape Breton.
+
+On the 21st we sighted the island and Cap de Raye. [30] On the 29th the
+Montagnais savages, perceiving us from All Devils' Point, [31] threw
+themselves into their canoes and came to meet us, being so thin and
+hideous-looking that I did not recognize them. At once they began crying
+for bread, saying that they were dying of hunger. This led us to conclude
+that the winter had not been severe, and consequently the hunting poor,
+which matter we have alluded to in previous voyages.
+
+Having arrived on board of our vessel they examined the faces of all, and
+as I was not to be seen anywhere they asked where Monsieur de Champlain
+was, and were answered that I had remained in France. But this they would
+not think of believing, and an old man among them came to me in a corner
+where I was walking, not desiring to be recognized as yet, and taking me by
+the ear, for he suspected who it was, saw the scar of the arrow wound,
+which I received at the defeat of the Iroquois. At this he cried out, and
+all the others after him, with great demonstrations of joy, saying, Your
+people are awaiting you at the harbor of Tadoussac.
+
+The same day we arrived at Tadoussac, and although we had set out last,
+nevertheless arrived first, Sieur Boyer of Rouen arriving with the same
+tide. From this it is evident that to set out before the season is simply
+rushing into the ice. When we had anchored, our friends came out to us,
+and, after informing us how everything was at the habitation, began to
+dress three _outardes_ [32] and two hares, which they had brought, throwing
+the entrails overboard, after which the poor savages rushed, and, like
+famished beasts, devoured them without drawing. They also scraped off with
+their nails the fat with which our vessel had been coated, eating it
+gluttonously as if they had found some great delicacy.
+
+The next day two vessels arrived from St. Malo, which had set out before
+the oppositions had been settled and the commission been published in
+Normandy. I proceeded on board, accompanied by L'Ange. The Sieurs de la
+Moinerie and la Tremblaye were in command, to whom I read the commission of
+the King, and the prohibition against violating it on penalties attached to
+the same. They replied that they were subjects and faithful servants of His
+Majesty, and that they would obey his commands; and I then had attached to
+a post in the port the arms and commission of His Majesty, that no ground
+for ignorance might be claimed.
+
+On the 2d of May, seeing two shallops equipped to go to the Falls, I
+embarked with the before-mentioned L'Ange in one of them. We had very bad
+weather, so that the masts of our shallop were broken, and had it not been
+for the preserving hand of God we should have been lost, as was before our
+eyes a shallop from St Malo, which was going to the Isle d'Orleans, those
+on board of which however being saved.
+
+On the 7th we arrived at Quebec, where we found in good condition those who
+had wintered there, they not having been sick; they told us that the winter
+had not been severe, and that the river had not frozen. The trees also were
+beginning to put forth leaves and the fields to be decked with flowers.
+
+On the 13th we set out from Quebec for the Falls of St. Louis, where we
+arrived on the 21st, finding there one of, our barques which had set out
+after us from Tadoussac, and which had traded some with a small troop of
+Algonquins, who came from the war with the Iroquois, and had with them two
+prisoners. Those in the barque gave them to understand that I had come with
+a number of men to assist them in their wars, according to the promise I
+had made them in previous years; also that I desired to go to their country
+and enter into an alliance with all their friends, at which they were
+greatly pleased. And, inasmuch as they were desirous of returning to their
+country to assure their friends of their victory, see their wives, and put
+to death their prisoners in a festive _tabagie_, they left us pledges of
+their return, which they promised should be before the middle of the first
+moon, according to their reckoning, their shields made of wood and elk
+leather, and a part of their bows and arrows. I regretted very much that I
+was not prepared to go with them to their country.
+
+Three days after, three canoes arrived with Algonquins, who had come from
+the interior, with some articles of merchandise which they bartered. They
+told me that the bad treatment which the savages had received the year
+before had discouraged them from coming any more, and that they did not
+believe that I would ever return to their country on account of the wrong
+impressions which those jealous of me had given them respecting me;
+wherefore twelve hundred men had gone to the war, having no more hope from
+the French, who, they did not believe, would return again to their country.
+
+This intelligence greatly disheartened the merchants, as they had made a
+great purchase of merchandise, with the expectation that the savages would
+come, as they had been accustomed to. This led me to resolve, as I engaged
+in my explorations, to pass through their country, in order to encourage
+those who had stayed back, with an assurance of the good treatment they
+would receive, and of the large amount of good merchandise at the Fall, and
+also of the desire I had to assist them in their war. For carrying out this
+purpose I requested three canoes and three savages to guide us, but after
+much difficulty obtained only two and one savage, and this by means of some
+presents made them.
+
+ENDNOTES:
+
+30. The _island_ refers to New Foundland. Cap de Raye, still known as Cape
+ Ray, was on the southwestern angle of New Foundland.
+
+31. Now called Point aux Vaches. It was sometimes called All-Devils'
+ Point. _Vide_ note 136, Vol. I. p. 235.
+
+32. _Outardes_. Sometimes written _houtardes_, and _Oltardes_. The name
+ outarde or bustard, the _otis_ of ornithologists, a land bird of
+ Europe, was applied to a species of goose in Canada at a very early
+ period.
+
+ The outarde is mentioned by Cartier in 1535, and the name may have been
+ originally applied by the fishermen and fur-traders at a much earlier
+ period, doubtless on account of some fancied resemblance which they saw
+ to the lesser bustard or outarde, which was about the size of the
+ English pheasant. _Vide Pennant's British Zooelogy_, Vol. I. p. 379.
+ Cartier, Champlain, Lescarbot, Baron La Hontan, Potherie, and Charlvoix
+ mention the outarde in catalogues of water-fowl in which _oye_, the
+ goose, is likewise mentioned. They very clearly distinguish it from the
+ class which they commonly considered _oyes_, or geese. Cartier, for
+ instance, says, Il y a aussi grand nombre d'oyseaulx, scauoir grues,
+ signes, _oltardes, oyes sauuages, blanches, & grises_. Others speak of
+ _outardes et oyes_. They do not generally describe it with
+ particularity. Champlain, however, in describing the turkey, _cocq
+ d'Inde_, on the coast of New England, says, _aussi gros qu'vne outarde,
+ qui est une espece d'oye_. Father Pierre Biard writes, _et au mesme
+ temps les outardes arriuent du midy, qui sont grosses cannes au double
+ des nostres_. From these statements it is obvious that the outarde was
+ a species of goose, but was so small that it could well be described as
+ a large duck. In New France there were at least four species of the
+ goose, which might have come under the observation of the early
+ navigators and explorers. We give them in the order of their size, as
+ described in Coues' Key to North American Birds.
+
+ 1. Canada Goose, _Branta Canadensis_, SCOPOLI, 36 inches.
+ 2. Snow Goose, _Anser hyperboreus_, LINNAEUS, 30 inches.
+ 3. Am. White-fronted Goose, _Anser albifrons_, LINNAEUS, 27 inches.
+ 4. Brant Goose, _Branta bernicla_, SCOPOLI, 24 inches.
+
+ Recurring to the statement of Cartier above cited, it will be observed
+ that he mentions, besides the outarde, wild geese white and gray. The
+ first and largest of the four species above mentioned, the Canada
+ goose, _Branta Canadensis_, is gray, and the two next, the Snow goose
+ and White-fronted, would be classified as white. This disposes of three
+ of the four mentioned. The outarde of Cartier would therefore be the
+ fourth species in the list, viz. the Brant goose. _Branta bernicla_.
+ This is the smallest species found on our northern coast, and might
+ naturally be described, as stated by Father Biard, as a large duck. It
+ is obvious that the good Father could not have described the Canada
+ goose, the largest of the four species, as a large duck, and the white
+ geese have never been supposed to be referred to under the name of
+ outarde. The Brant goose, to which all the evidence which we have been
+ able to find in the Canadian authorities seems to point as the outarde
+ of early times, is common in our markets in its season, but our
+ market-men, unaccustomed to make scientific distinctions, are puzzled
+ to decide whether it should be classed as a goose or a duck. It is not
+ improbable that the early voyagers to our northern latitudes, unable to
+ decide to which of these classes this water-fowl properly belonged, and
+ seeing in it a fancied resemblance to the lesser outarde, with which
+ they were familiar, gave it for sake of the distinction, but
+ nevertheless inappropriately, the name of outarde. The reader is
+ referred to the following authorities.
+
+ _Vide Brief Recit_ par Jacques Cartier, 1545. D'Avezac ed., p. 33;
+ _Champlain_, Quebec ed., p. 220; _Jesuite Relations_, 1616, p. 10; _Le
+ Grand Voyage du Pays des Hurons_, par Sagard, Paris, 1632, p. 301;
+ _Dictionaire de la Langue Hurone_, par Sagard, Paris, 1632, _oyseaux;
+ Letters to the Dutchess of Lesdiguieres_, By Fr. Xa. de Charlevoix,
+ London. 1763, p. 88; _Le Jeune, Relations des Jesuites_, 1633, P. 4,
+ 1636, p. 47; _Histoire de l'Amerique Septentrionale_, par de la
+ Potherie, Paris, 1722, Vol. I. pp. 20, 172, 212, 308; _Lescarbot,
+ Histoire de la Nouvelle France_, pp. 369, 582, 611.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER III.
+
+DEPARTURE TO DISCOVER THE NORTH SEA, ON THE GROUND OF THE REPORT MADE ME IN
+REGARD TO IT. DESCRIPTION OF SEVERAL RIVERS, LAKES AND ISLANDS, THE FALLS
+OF THE CHAUDIERE AND OTHER FALLS.
+
+
+Now, as I had only two canoes, I could take with me but four men, among
+whom was one named Nicholas de Vignau, the most impudent liar that has been
+seen for a long time, as the sequel of this narrative will show. He had
+formerly spent the winter with the savages, and I had sent him on
+explorations the preceding years. He reported to me, on his return to Paris
+in 1612, that he had seen the North Sea; that the river of the Algonquins
+came from a lake which emptied into it; and that in seventeen days one
+could go from the Falls of St. Louis to this sea and back again; that he
+had seen the wreck and _debris_ of an English ship that had been wrecked,
+on board of which were eighty men, who had escaped to the shore, and whom
+the savages killed because the English endeavored to take from them by
+force their Indian corn and other necessaries of life; and that he had seen
+the scalps which these savages had flayed off, according to their custom,
+which they would show me, and that they would likewise give me a young
+English boy whom they had kept for me. This intelligence had greatly
+pleased me, for I thought that I had almost found that for which I had for
+a long time been searching. Accordingly I enjoined upon him to tell me the
+truth, in order that I might inform the King, and warned him that if he
+gave utterance to a lie he was putting the rope about his neck, assuring
+him on the other hand that, if his narrative were true, he could be certain
+of being well rewarded. He again assured me, with stronger oaths than ever;
+and in order to play his _role_ better he gave me a description of the
+country, which he said he had made as well as he was able. Accordingly the
+confidence which I saw in him, his entire frankness as it seemed, the
+description which he had prepared, the wreck and _debris_ of the ship, and
+the things above mentioned, had an appearance of probability, in connection
+with the voyage of the English to Labrador in 1612, where they found a
+strait, in which they sailed as far as the 63d degree of latitude and the
+290th of longitude, wintering at the 53d degree and losing some vessels, as
+their report proves.[33] These circumstances inducing me to believe that
+what he said was true, I made a report of the same to the Chancellor, [34]
+which I showed to Marshal de Brissac,[35] President Jeannin, [36] and other
+Seigneurs of the Court, who told me that I ought to visit the place in
+person. For this reason I requested Sieur Georges, a merchant of La
+Rochelle, to give him a passage in his ship, which he willingly did, and
+during the voyage he questioned him as to his object in making it; and,
+since it was not of any profit to him, he asked if he expected any pay, to
+which the young man answered that he did not, that he did not expect
+anything, from any one but the King, and that he undertook the voyage only
+to show me the North Sea, which he had seen. He made an affidavit of this
+at La Rochelle before two notaries.
+
+Now as I took leave on Whitsuntide, [37] of all the principal men to whose
+prayers I commended myself, and also to those of all others, I said to him
+in their presence that if what he had previously said was not true he must
+not give me the trouble to undertake the journey, which involved many
+dangers. Again he affirmed all that he had said, on peril of his life.
+
+Accordingly, our canoes being laden with some provisions, our arms, and a
+few articles of merchandise for making presents to the savages, I set out
+on Monday the 27th of May from Isle St. Helene with four Frenchmen and one
+savage, a parting salute being given me with some rounds from small
+pieces. This day we went only to the Falls of St. Louis, a league up the
+river, the bad weather not allowing us to go any farther.
+
+On the 29th we passed the Falls, [38] partly by land, partly by water, it
+being necessary for us to carry our canoes, clothes, victuals, and arms on
+our shoulders, no small matter for persons not accustomed to it. After
+going two leagues beyond the Falls, we entered a lake, [39] about twelve
+leagues in circuit, into which three rivers empty; one coming from the
+west, from the direction of the Ochateguins, distant from one hundred and
+fifty to two hundred leagues from the great Falls; [40] another from the
+south and the country of the Iroquois, a like distance off; [41] and the
+other from the north and the country of the Algonquins and Nebicerini, also
+about the same distance. [42] This river on the north, according to the
+report of the savages, comes from a source more remote, and passes by
+tribes unknown to them and about three hundred leagues distant.
+
+This lake is filled with fine large islands, containing only pasturage
+land, where there is fine hunting, deer and fowl being plenty. Fish are
+abundant. The country bordering the lake is covered with extensive
+forests. We proceeded to pass the night at the entrance to this lake,
+making barricades against the Iroquois, who roam in these regions in order
+to surprise their enemies; and I am sure that if they were to find us they
+would give us as good a welcome as them, for which reason we kept a good
+watch all night. On the next day I took the altitude of the place, and
+found it in latitude 45 deg. 18'. About three o'clock in the afternoon we
+entered the river which comes from the north, and, passing a small fall
+[43] by land so as to favor our canoes, we proceeded to a little island,
+where we spent the remainder of the night.
+
+On the last day of May we passed another lake, [44] seven or eight leagues
+long and three broad, containing several islands. The neighboring country
+is very level, except in some places, where there are pine-covered hills.
+We passed a fall called by the inhabitants of the country Quenechouan,[45]
+which is filled with stones and rocks, and where the water runs with great
+velocity. We had to get into the water and drag our canoes along the shore
+with a rope. Half a league from there we passed another little fall by
+rowing, which makes one sweat. Great skill is required in passing these
+falls, in order to avoid the eddies and surf, in which they abound; but the
+savages do this with the greatest possible dexterity, winding about and
+going by the easiest places, which they recognize at a glance.
+
+On Saturday, the 1st of June, we passed two other falls; the first half a
+league long, the second a league, in which we had much difficulty; for the
+rapidity of the current is so great that it makes a frightful noise, and
+produces, as it descends from stage to stage, so white a foam everywhere
+that the water cannot be seen at all. This fall is strewn with rocks, and
+contains some islands here and there covered with pines and white cedars.
+This was the place where we had a hard time; for, not being able to carry
+our canoes by land on account of the density of the wood, we had to drag
+them in the water with ropes, and in drawing mine I came near losing my
+life, as it crossed into one of the eddies, and if I had not had the good
+fortune to fall between two rocks the canoe would have dragged me in,
+inasmuch as I was unable to undo quickly enough the rope which was wound
+around my hand, and which hurt me severely and came near cutting it off. In
+this danger I cried to God and began to pull my canoe, which was returned
+to me by the refluent water, such as occurs in these falls. Having thus
+escaped I thanked God, begging Him to preserve us. Later our savage came to
+help me, but I was out of danger. It is not strange that I was desirous of
+preserving my canoe, for if it had been lost it would have been necessary
+to remain, or wait until some savages came that way, a poor hope for those
+who have nothing to dine on, and who are not accustomed to such
+hardship. As for our Frenchmen, they did not have any better luck, and
+several times came near losing their lives; but the Divine Goodness
+preserved us all. During the remainder of the day we rested, having done
+enough.
+
+The next day we fell in with fifteen canoes of savages called
+_Quenongebin_, [46] in a river, after we had passed a small lake, four
+leagues long and two broad. They had been informed of my coming by those
+who had passed the Falls of St. Louis, on their way from the war with the
+Iroquois. I was very glad to meet them, as were they also to meet me, but
+they were astonished to see me in this country with so few companions, and
+with only one savage. Accordingly, after saluting each other after the
+manner of the country, I desired them not to go any farther until I had
+informed them of my plan. To this they assented, and we encamped on an
+island.
+
+The next day I explained to them that I was on my way to their country to
+visit them, and fulfil the promise I had previously made them, and that if
+they had determined to go to the war it would be very agreeable to me,
+inasmuch as I had brought some companions with this view, at which they
+were greatly pleased; and having told them that I wished to go farther in
+order to notify the other tribes, they wanted to deter me, saying that the
+way was bad, and that we had seen nothing up to this point. Wherefore I
+asked them to give me one of their number to take charge of our second
+canoe, and also to serve us as guide, since our conductors were not
+acquainted any farther. This they did willingly, and in return I made them
+a present and gave them one of our Frenchmen, the least indispensable, whom
+I sent back to the Falls with a leaf of my note-book, on which for want of
+paper I made a report of myself.
+
+Thus we parted, and continuing our course up the river we found another
+one, very fair and broad, which comes from a nation called _Ouescharini_,
+[47] who live north of it, a distance of four days' journey from the
+mouth. This river is very pleasant in consequence of the fine islands it
+contains, and the fair and open woods with which its shores are
+bordered. The land is very good for tillage.
+
+On the fourth day we passed near another river coming from the north, where
+tribes called _Algonquins_ live. This river falls into the great river
+St. Lawrence, three leagues below the Falls of St. Louis, forming a large
+island of nearly forty leagues. [48] This river is not broad, but filled
+with a countless number of falls, very hard to pass. Sometimes these tribes
+go by way of this river in order to avoid encounters with their enemies,
+knowing that they will not try to find them in places so difficult of
+access.
+
+Where this river has its debouchure is another coming from the south, [49]
+at the mouth of which is a marvellous fall. For it descends a height of
+twenty or twenty-five fathoms [50] with such impetuosity that it makes an
+arch nearly four hundred paces broad. The savages take pleasure in passing
+under it, not wetting themselves, except from the spray that is thrown off.
+There is an island in the middle of the river which, like all the country
+round about, is covered with pines and white cedars. When the savages
+desire to enter the river they ascend the mountain, carrying their canoes,
+and go half a league by land. The neighboring country is filled with all
+sorts of game, so that the savages often make a stop here. The Iroquois
+also go there sometimes and surprise them while making the passage.
+
+We passed a fall [51] a league from there, which is half a league broad,
+and has a descent of six or seven fathoms. There are many little islands,
+which are, however, nothing more than rough and dangerous rocks covered
+with a poor sort of brushwood. The water falls in one place with such force
+upon a rock that it has hollowed out in course of time a large and deep
+basin, in which the water has a circular motion and forms large eddies in
+the middle, so that the savages call it _Asticou_, which signifies boiler.
+This cataract produces such a noise in this basin that it is heard for more
+than two leagues. The savages when passing here observe a ceremony which we
+shall speak of in its place. We had much trouble in ascending by rowing
+against a strong current, in order to reach the foot of the fall. Here the
+savages took their canoes, my Frenchmen and myself, our arms, provisions,
+and other necessaries, and we passed over the rough rocks for the distance
+of about a quarter of a league, the extent of the fall. Then we embarked,
+being obliged afterwards to land a second time and go about three hundred
+paces through copse-wood, after which we got into the water in order to get
+our canoes over the sharp rocks, the trouble attending which may be
+imagined. I took the altitude of this place, which I found to be in
+latitude 45 deg. 38'. [52]
+
+In the afternoon we entered a lake, [53] five leagues long and two wide, in
+which there are very fine islands covered with vines, nut-trees, and other
+excellent kinds of trees. Ten or twelve leagues above we passed some
+islands covered with pines. The land is sandy, and there is found here a
+root which dyes a crimson color, with which the savages paint their faces,
+as also little gewgaws after their manner. There is also a mountain range
+along this river, and the surrounding country seems to be very
+unpromising. The rest of the day we passed on a very pleasant island.
+
+The next day we proceeded on our course to a great fall, nearly three
+leagues broad, in which the water falls a height of ten or twelve fathoms
+in a slope, making a marvellous noise. [54] It is filled with a vast number
+of islands, covered with pines and cedars. In order to pass it we were
+obliged to give up our maize or Indian corn, and some few other provisions
+we had, together with our least necessary clothes, retaining only our arms
+and lines, to afford us means of support from hunting and fishing as place
+and luck might permit. Thus lightened we passed, sometimes rowing,
+sometimes carrying our canoes and arms by land, the fall, which is a league
+and a half long, [55] and in which our savages, who are indefatigable in
+this work and accustomed to endure such hardships, aided us greatly.
+
+Continuing our course, we passed two other falls, one by land, the other
+with oar and poles standing up. Then we entered a lake, [56] six or seven
+leagues long, into which flows a river coming from the south, [57] on which
+at a distance of five days' journey from the other river [58] live a people
+called _Matou-oueescarini_ [59] The lands about the before-mentioned lake
+are sandy and covered with pines, which have been almost entirely burned
+down by the savages. There are some islands, in one of which we rested
+ourselves. Here we saw a number of fine red cypresses,[60] the first I had
+seen in this country, out of which I made a cross, which I planted at one
+end of the island, on an elevated and conspicuous spot, with the arms of
+France, as I had done in other places where we had stopped. I called this
+island _Sainte Croix_.
+
+On the 6th we set out from this island of St. Croix, where the river is a
+league and a half broad, and having made eight or ten leagues we passed a
+small fall by oar, and a number of islands of various sizes. Here our
+savages left the sacks containing their provisions and their less necessary
+articles, in order to be lighter for going overland and avoiding several
+falls which it was necessary to pass. There was a great dispute between our
+savages and our impostor, who affirmed that there was no danger by way of
+the falls, and that we ought to go that way. Our savages said to him, You
+are tired of living, and to me, that I ought not to believe him, and that
+he did not tell the truth. Accordingly, having several times observed that
+he had no knowledge of the places, I followed the advice of the savages,
+which was fortunate for me, for he fought for dangers in order to ruin me
+or to disgust me with the undertaking, as he has since confessed, a
+statement of which will be given hereafter. We crossed accordingly towards
+the west the river, which extended northward. I took the altitude of this
+place and found it in latitude 46 deg. 40'.[61] We had much difficulty in going
+this distance overland. I, for my part, was loaded only with three
+arquebuses, as many oars, my cloak, and some small articles. I cheered on
+our men, who were somewhat more heavily loaded, but more troubled by the
+mosquitoes than by their loads. Thus after passing four small ponds and
+having gone a distance of two and a half leagues, we were so wearied that
+it was impossible to go farther, not having eaten for twenty-four hours
+anything but a little broiled fish without seasoning, for we had left our
+provisions behind, as I mentioned before. Accordingly we rested on the
+border of a pond, which was very pleasant, and made a fire to drive away
+the mosquitoes, which annoyed us greatly, whose persistency is so
+marvellous that one cannot describe it. Here we cast our lines to catch
+some fish.
+
+The next day we passed this pond, which was perhaps a league long. Then we
+went by land three leagues through a country worse than we had yet seen,
+since the winds had blown down the pines on top of each other. This was no
+slight inconvenience, as it was necessary to go now over, now under, these
+trees. In this way we reached a lake, six leagues long and two wide, [62]
+very abundant in fish, the neighboring people doing their fishing there.
+Near this lake is a settlement of savages, who till the soil and gather
+harvests of maize. Their chief is named _Nibachis_, who came to visit us
+with his followers, astonished that we could have passed the falls and bad
+roads in order to reach them. After offering us tobacco, according to their
+custom, he began to address his companions, saying, that we must have
+fallen from the clouds, for he knew not how we could have made the journey,
+and that they who lived in the country had much trouble in traversing these
+bad ways: and he gave them to understand that I accomplished all that I set
+my mind upon; in short, that he believed respecting me all that the other
+savages had told him. Aware that we were hungry, he gave us some fish,
+which we ate, and after our meal I explained to him, through Thomas, our
+interpreter, the pleasure I had in meeting them, that I had come to this
+country to assist them in their wars, and that I desired to go still
+farther to see some other chiefs for the same object, at which they were
+glad and promised me assistance. They showed me their gardens and the
+fields, where they had maize. Their soil is sandy, for which reason they
+devote themselves more to hunting than to tillage, unlike the Ochateguins.
+[63] When they wish to make a piece of land arable, they burn down the
+trees, which is very easily done, as they are all pines, and filled with
+rosin. The trees having been burned, they dig up the ground a little, and
+plant their maize kernel by kernel, [64] like those in Florida. At the time
+I was there it was only four fingers high.
+
+ENDNOTES:
+
+33. _Vide_ Vol. II. p. 171, note 297, for an account of Henry Hudson, to
+ whom this statement refers. De Vignau had undoubtedly heard rumors
+ concerning Hudson's expedition to the bay that bears his name in the
+ years 1610-11, out of which he fabricated the fine story of his
+ pretended discovery. Longitude at that time was reckoned from the
+ island of Ferro, one of the Canaries. Proceeding from west to east, the
+ 290 deg. would pass through Hudson's Bay, as may be seen by consulting any
+ early French map. _Vide_ Bellin's _Carte du Globe Terrestre_, 1764.
+
+34. Nicholas Brulart de Sillery, who was born at Sillery, in France, in
+ 1544, and died in the same place in 1624. He rendered signal service to
+ Henry IV. Among other public acts he negotiated the peace of Vervins
+ between France and Spain in 1598. He was appointed grand chancellor of
+ France in 1607. Henry IV. said of him, Avec mon chanclier qui ne fait
+ pas le latin et mon connetable (Henri de Montmorency), qui ne fait ni
+ lire ni ecrire, je puis venir a bout des affairs les plus difficiles.
+
+35. For some account of Marshal de Brissac, _vide_ Vol. I. p. 17, note 16.
+
+36. _Vide_ Vol. I. p. 112, note 73. President Jeannin was a most suitable
+ person to consult on this subject, as he was deeply interested in the
+ discovery of a northwest passage to India. When minister at the Hague
+ he addressed a letter bearing date January 21st, 1609, to Henry IV. of
+ France, containing an account of his indirect negotiations with Henry
+ Hudson, for a voyage to discover a shorter passage to India. A copy of
+ this interesting letter, both in French and English, may be found in
+ _Henry Hudson the Navigator_, by G. M. Asher, LL.D., Hakluyt Society,
+ London, 1860, p. 244.
+
+37. The festival of Whitsunday occurred on the 26th May. _Laverdiere in
+ loco_.
+
+38. The Falls of St Louis.
+
+39. Lake St. Louis.
+
+40. Champlain is here speaking of the river St. Lawrence, which flows into
+ Lake St. Louis slightly south of west.
+
+41. Riviere de Loup, now known as the Chateauguay.
+
+42. The River Ottawa or a branch of it flows into Lake St. Louis from the
+ north, although its course is rather from the west. It was often called
+ the River of the Algonquins. It approaches comparatively near to Lake
+ Nipissing, the home of the Nipissirini. The sources of the Ottawa are
+ northeast of Lake Nipissing, a distance of from one to three hundred
+ miles. The distances here given by Champlain are only general estimates
+ gathered from the Indians, and are necessarily inaccurate.
+
+43. Rapide de Brussi, by which the river flows from the Lake of
+ Two Mountains into Lake St Louis.
+
+44. _Lac de Soissons_, now called Lake of Two Mountains _Vide_ Vol. I.
+ p. 294.
+
+45. This is the first of a series of falls now known as the Long Fall.
+
+46. _Quenongebin_. Laverdiere makes, this the same as the Kinounchepirini
+ of Vimont. It was an Algonquin nation situated south of Allumette
+ Island. _Vide Jesuite Relations_, Quebec ed, 1640, p. 34.
+
+47. _Ouescharini_. These people, called Ouaouechkairini by Vimont, appear
+ to have dwelt on the stream now known as the _Riviere de Petite
+ Nation_, rising in a system of lakes, among which are Lake Simon,
+ Whitefish Lake, Long Lake, and Lake Des Isles. _Vide Jesuite
+ Relations_, 1640, p. 34. The tribe here mentioned was subsequently
+ called the Little Nation of the Algonquins hence the name of the
+ river. _Laverdiere_.
+
+48. This passage is exceedingly obscure. Laverdiere supposes that part of a
+ sentence was left out by the printer. If so it is remarkable that
+ Champlain did not correct it in his edition of 1632. Laverdiere thinks
+ the river here spoken of is the Gatineau, and that the savages
+ following up this stream went by a portage to the St. Maurice, and
+ passing down reached the St. Lawrence _thirty_ leagues, and not
+ _three_, below the Falls of Saint Louis. The three rivers thus named
+ inclose or form an island of about the extent described in the
+ text. This explanation is plausible. The passage amended would read,
+ "This river _extends near another which_ falls into the great river
+ St. Lawrence thirty leagues below the falls of St. Louis." We know of
+ no other way in which the passage can be rationally explained.
+
+49. Rideau, at the mouth of which is Green Island, referred to in the text
+ below.
+
+50. The fall in the Rideau is thirty-four feet, according to the Edinburgh
+ Gazetteer of the World. The estimate of Champlain is so far out of the
+ way that it seems not unlikely that feet were intended instead of
+ fathoms. _Vide_ Vol. I. pp. 301, 302.
+
+51. The Chaudiere Falls, just above the present city of Ottawa, the
+ greatest height of which is about forty feet "Arrayed in every
+ imaginable variety of form, in vast dark masses, in graceful cascades,
+ or in tumbling spray, they have been well described as a hundred rivers
+ struggling for a passage. Not the least interesting feature they
+ present is the Lost Chaudiere, where a large body of water is quietly
+ sucked down, and disappears underground" _Vide Canada_ by W. H Smith.
+ Vol. I. p. 120. Also Vol I. p, 120 of this work.
+
+52. The latitude of the Chaudiere Falls is about 45 deg. 27'.
+
+53. Chaudiere Lake, which was only an expansion of the River Ottawa.
+
+54. Rapide des Chats.
+
+55. This probably refers to that part of the fall which was more difficult
+ to pass.
+
+56. Lake des Chats. The name _des chats_ appears to have been given to this
+ Lake, the Rapids, and the _Nation des chats_, on account of the great
+ number of the _loup cervier_, or wild cats, _chats sauvages_, found in
+ this region. Cf. _Le Grande Voyage du Pays des Hurons_, par Sagard,
+ Paris, 1632, p. 307.
+
+57. Madawaskca River, an affluent of the Ottawa, uniting with it at Fitz
+ Roy.
+
+58. Probably an allusion to the River St. Lawrence.
+
+59. This is the same tribe alluded to by Vimont under the name
+ _Mataouchkarmi_, as dwelling south of Allumette Island. _Vide Relations
+ des Jesuites_, 1640, Quebec ed., p. 34.
+
+60. Cypres, Red Cedar or Savin, _Juniperus Virginiana_. _Vide_ Vol. II.
+ note 168.
+
+61. They were now, perhaps, two miles below Portage du Fort, at the point
+ on the Ottawa nearest to the system of lakes through which they were to
+ pass, and where, as stated in the text, the Ottawa, making an angle,
+ begins to flow directly from the north. The latitude, as here given, is
+ even more than usually incorrect, being too high by more than a degree.
+ The true latitude is about 43 deg. 37'. _Vide Walker_ and _Miles's Atlas of
+ Dominion of Canada_. Note 62 will explain the cause of this
+ inexactness.
+
+62. Muskrat Lake. On Champlain's map of 1632 will be seen laid down a
+ succession of lakes or ponds, together with the larger one, now known
+ as Muskrat Lake, on the borders of which are figured the dwellings of
+ the savages referred to in the text. The pond which they passed is the
+ last in the series before reaching Muskrat Lake. On the direct route
+ between this pond and the lake, known as the Muskrat Portage road, the
+ course undoubtedly traversed by Champlain, there was found in 1867, in
+ the, township of Ross, an astrolabe, an instrument used in taking
+ latitudes, on which is the date, 1603. It is supposed to have been lost
+ by Champlain on his present expedition. The reasons for this
+ supposition have been stated in several brochures recently issued, one
+ by Mr. O. H. Marshall of Buffalo, entitled _Discovery of an Astrolabe
+ supposed to have been left by Champlain in 1613_, New York, 1879;
+ reprinted from the _Magazine of American History_ for March of that
+ year. Another, _Champlain's Astrolabe lost on the 7th of June, 1613,
+ and found in August, 1867_, by A. J Russell of Ottawa, Montreal,
+ 1879. And a third entitled _The Astrolabe of Samuel Champlain and
+ Geoffrey Chaucer_, by Henry Scadding, D.D., of Toronto, 1880. All of
+ these writers agree in the opinion that the instrument was probably
+ lost by Champlain on his expedition up the Ottawa in 1613. For the
+ argument _in extenso_ the reader is referred to the brochures above
+ cited.
+
+ [Illustration of an astrolabe.]
+
+ Mr. Russell, who examined the astrolabe thus found with great care and
+ had it photographed, describes it as a circular plate having a diameter
+ of five inches and five eighths. "It is of place brass, very dark with
+ age, one eighth of an inch thick above, increasing to six sixteenths of
+ an inch below, to give it steadiness when suspended, which apparently
+ was intended to be increased by hanging a weight on the little
+ projecting ring at the bottom of it, in using it on ship-board. Its
+ suspending ring is attached by a double hinge of the nature of a
+ universal joint. Its circle is divided into single degrees, graduated
+ from its perpendicular of suspension. The double-bladed index, the
+ pivot of which passes through the centre of the astrolabe, has slits
+ and eyelets in the projecting fights that are on it."
+
+ We give on the preceding page an engraving of this astrolabe from a
+ photograph, which presents a sufficiently accurate outline of the
+ instrument. The plate was originally made to illustrate Mr. Marshall's
+ article in the Magazine of American History, and we are indebted to the
+ courtesy of the proprietors of the Magazine, Messrs. A. S. Barnes and
+ Company of New York, for its use for our present purpose.
+
+ The astrolabe, as an instrument for taking the altitude of the stars or
+ the sun, had long been in use. Thomas Blundevile, who wrote in 1622,
+ says he had seen three kinds, and that the astrolabe of Stofflerus had
+ then been in use a hundred years. It had been improved by Gemma
+ Frisius. Mr. Blagrave had likewise improved upon the last-mentioned,
+ and his instrument was at that time in general use in England. The
+ astrolabe continued to be employed in Great Britain in taking altitudes
+ for more than a century subsequent to this, certainly till Hadley's
+ Quadrant was invented, which was first announced in 1731.
+
+ The astrolabes which had the broadest disks were more exact, as they
+ were projected on a larger scale, but as they were easily jostled by
+ the wind or the movement of the ship at sea, they could with difficulty
+ be employed. But Mr. Blundevile informs us that "the Spaniards doe
+ commonly make their astrolabes narrow and weighty, which for the most
+ part are not much above five inches broad, and yet doe weigh at the
+ least foure pound, & to that end the lower part is made a great deale
+ thicker than the upper part towards the ring or handle." _Vide
+ M. Blendeale his Exercises_, London, 1622, pp. 595, 597. This Spanish
+ instrument, it will be observed, is very similar to that found on the
+ Old Portage road, and the latter may have been of Spanish make.
+
+ In order to take the latitude in Champlain's day, at least three
+ distinct steps or processes were necessary, and the following
+ directions might have been given.
+
+ I. Let the astrolabe be suspended so that it shall hang plumb. Direct
+ the index or diopter to the sun at noon, so that the same ray of light
+ may shine through both holes in the two tablets or pinules on the
+ diopter, and the diopter will point to the degree of the sun's meridian
+ altitude indicated on the outer rim of the astrolabe.
+
+ II. Ascertain the exact degree of the sun's declination for that day,
+ by a table calculated for that purpose, which accompanies the
+ astrolabe.
+
+ III. Subtract the declination, so found, if it be northerly, from the
+ meridian altitude; or if the declination be southerly, add the
+ declination to the meridian altitude, and the result, subtracted from
+ 90 deg., will give the latitude.
+
+ In these several processes of taking the latitude there are numerous
+ possibilities of inexactness. It does not appear that any correction
+ was made for refraction of light, or the precession of the equinoxes.
+ But the most important source of inaccuracy was in the use of the
+ astrolabe whose disk was so small that its divisions could not be
+ carried beyond degrees, and consequently minutes were arrived at by
+ sheer estimation, and usually when the work was completed, the error
+ was not less than one fourth or one half of a degree, and it was often
+ much more.
+
+ This accounts fully for the inaccuracies of Champlain's latitudes from
+ first to last throughout his entire explorations, as tested by the very
+ exact instruments and tables now in use. No better method of
+ determining the latitude existed at that day, and consequently the
+ historian is warned not to rely upon the latitude alone as given by the
+ early navigators and explorers in identifying the exact localities
+ which they visited.
+
+63. Subsequently called Hurons.
+
+64. _Vide_ Vol. I. p. 49; Vol. II. note 219.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER IV.
+
+CONTINUATION.--ARRIVAL AT THE ABODE OF TESSOUAT, AND HIS FAVORABLE
+RECEPTION OF ME.--CHARACTER OF THEIR CEMETERIES--THE SAVAGES PROMISE ME
+FOUR CANOES FOR CONTINUING MY JOURNEY, WHICH THEY HOWEVER SHORTLY AFTER
+REFUSE.--ADDRESS OF THE SAVAGES TO DISSUADE ME FROM MY UNDERTAKING, IN
+WHICH THEY REPRESENT ITS DIFFICULTIES--MY REPLY TO THESE OBJECTIONS.--
+TESSOUAT ACCUSES MY GUIDE OF LYING, AND OF NOT HAVING BEEN WHERE HE SAID HE
+HAD.--THE LATTER MAINTAINS HIS VERACITY--I URGE THEM TO GIVE ME CANOES.--
+SEVERAL REFUSALS.--MY GUIDE CONVICTED OF FALSEHOOD, AND HIS CONFESSION.
+
+
+Nibachis had two canoes fitted out, to conduct me to another chief, named
+Tessoueat, [65] who lived eight leagues from him, on the border of a great
+lake, through which flows the river which we had left, and which extends
+northward. Accordingly we crossed the lake in a west-northwesterly
+direction, a distance of nearly seven leagues. Landing there, we went a
+league towards the northeast through a very fine country, where are small
+beaten paths, along which one can go easily. Thus we arrived on the shore
+of the lake, [66] where the dwelling of Tessoueat was. He was accompanied by
+a neighboring chieftain, and was greatly amazed to see me, saying that he
+thought I was a dream, and that he did not believe his eyes. Thence we
+crossed on to an island, [67] where their cabins are, which are poorly
+constructed out of the bark of trees. The island is covered with oaks,
+pines, and elms, and is not subject to inundations, like the other islands
+in the lake.
+
+This island is strongly situated; for at its two ends, and where the river
+enters the lake, there are troublesome falls, the roughness of which makes
+the island difficult of access. They have accordingly taken up their abode
+here in order to avoid the pursuit of their enemies. It is in latitude 47 deg.,
+[68] as also the lake, which is twenty leagues long, [69] and three or four
+wide. It abounds in fish; the hunting, however, is not especially good.
+
+On visiting the island, I observed their cemeteries, and was struck with
+wonder as I saw sepulchres of a shape like shrines, made of pieces of wood
+fixed in the ground at a distance of about three feet from each other, and
+intersecting at the upper end. On the intersections above they place a
+large piece of wood, and in front another upright piece, on which is carved
+roughly, as would be expected, the figure of the male or female interred.
+If it is a man, they add a shield, a sword attached to a handle after their
+manner, a mace, and bow and arrows. If it is a chief, there is a plume on
+his head, and some other _matachia_ or embellishment. If it is a child,
+they give it a bow and arrow; if a woman or girl, a boiler, an earthen
+vessel, a wooden spoon, and an oar. The entire sepulchre is six or seven
+feet long at most, and four wide; others are smaller. They are painted
+yellow and red, with various ornaments as neatly done as the carving. The
+deceased is buried with his dress of beaver or other skins which he wore
+when living, and they lay by his side all his possessions, as hatchets,
+knives, boilers, and awls, so that these things may serve him in the land
+whither he goes; for they believe in the immortality of the soul, as I have
+elsewhere observed. These carved sepulchres are only made for the warriors;
+for in respect to others they add no more than in the case of women, who
+are considered a useless class, accordingly but little is added in their
+case.
+
+Observing the poor quality of the soil, I asked them what pleasure they
+took in cultivating land so unpromising, since there was some much better,
+which they left barren and waste, as at the Falls of St. Louis. They
+answered that they were forced to do so in order to dwell in security, and
+that the roughness of the locality served them as a defence against their
+enemies. But they said that if I would make a settlement of French at the
+Falls of St. Louis, as I had promised, they would leave their abode and go
+and live near us, confident that their enemies would do them no harm while
+we were with them. I told them that we would this year collect wood and
+stone in order the coming year to build a fort and cultivate the land; upon
+hearing which they raised a great cry of applause. This conference having
+been finished, I asked all the chiefs and prominent men among them to
+assemble the next day on the main land, at the cabin of Tessoueat, who
+purposed to celebrate a _tabagie_ in my honor, adding that I would there
+tell them my plans. This they promised, and sent word to their neighbors to
+convene at the appointed place.
+
+The next day all the guests came, each with his porringer and wooden
+spoon. They seated themselves without order or ceremony on the ground in
+the cabin of Tessoueat, who distributed to them a kind of broth made of
+maize crushed between two stones, together with meat and fish which was cut
+into little pieces, the whole being boiled together without salt. They also
+had meat roasted on coals, and fish boiled apart, which he also
+distributed. In respect to myself, as I did not wish any of their chowder,
+which they prepare in a very dirty manner, I asked them for some fish and
+meat, that I might prepare it in my own way, which they gave me. For drink,
+we had fine clear water. Tessoueat, who gave the _tabagie_, entertained us
+without eating himself, according to their custom.
+
+The _tabagie_ being over, the young men, who are not present at the
+harangues and councils, and who during the _tabagies_ remain at the door of
+the cabins, withdrew, when all who remained began to fill their pipes, one
+and another offering me one. We then spent a full half-hour in this
+occupation, not a word being spoken, as is their custom.
+
+After smoking amply during so long a period of silence, I explained to
+them, through my interpreter, that the object of my journey was none other
+than to assure them of my friendship, and of the desire I had to assist
+them in their wars, as I had before done; that I had been prevented from
+coming the preceding year, as I had promised them, because the king had
+employed me in other wars, but that now he had ordered me to visit them and
+to fulfil my promises, and that for this purpose I had a number of men at
+the Falls of St. Louis. I told them that I was making an excursion in their
+territory to observe the fertility of their soil, their lakes and rivers,
+and the sea which they had told me was in their country; and that I desired
+to see a tribe distant six days' journey from them, called the
+_Nebicerini_, in order to invite them also to the war, and accordingly I
+asked them to give me four canoes with eight savages to guide me to these
+lands. And since the Algonquins are not great friends of the _Nebicerini_,
+[70] they seemed to listen to me with greater attention.
+
+After I had finished my discourse, they began again to smoke, and to confer
+among themselves in a very low voice respecting my propositions. Then
+Tessoueat in behalf of all the rest began and said, that they had always
+regarded me more friendly towards them than any Frenchman they had seen;
+that the proofs they had of this in the past made their confidence easier
+for the future: moreover, that I had shown myself in reality their friend,
+by encountering so many risks in coming to see them and invite them to the
+war, and that all these considerations obliged them to feel as kindly
+disposed towards me as towards their own children. But they said that I had
+the preceding year broken my promise, that two thousand savages had gone to
+the Falls with the expectation of finding me ready to go to the war, and
+making me presents, but that they had not found me and were greatly
+saddened, supposing that I was dead, as some persons had told them. He said
+also, that the French who were at the Falls did not want to help them in
+their wars, that they had been badly treated by certain ones, so that they
+had resolved among themselves not to go to the Falls again, and that this
+had caused them, as they did not expect to see me again, to go alone to the
+war, and that in fact twelve hundred of them had already gone. And since
+the greater part of their warriors were absent, they begged me to postpone
+the expedition to the following year, saying that they would communicate
+the matter to all the people of their country. In regard to the four
+canoes, which I asked for, they granted them to me, but with great
+reluctance, telling me that they were greatly displeased at the idea of
+such an undertaking, in view of the hardships which I would endure; that
+the people there were sorcerers, that they had caused the death of many of
+their own tribe by charms and poisoning, on which account they were not
+their friends: moreover they said that, as it regards war, I was not to
+think of them, as they were little-hearted. With these and many other
+considerations they endeavored to deter me from my purpose.
+
+But my sole desire on the other hand was to see this people, and enter into
+friendship with them, so that I might visit the North Sea. Accordingly,
+with a view to lessening the force of their objections, I said to them,
+that it was not far to the country in question; that the bad roads could
+not be worse than those I had already passed; that their witchcraft would
+have no power to harm me, as my God would preserve me from them; that I was
+also acquainted with their herbs, and would therefore beware of eating
+them; that I desired to make the two tribes mutual friends, and that I
+would to this end make presents to the other tribe, being assured that they
+would do something for me. In view of these reasons they granted me, as I
+have said, four canoes, at which I was very happy, forgetting all past
+hardships in the hope of seeing this sea, as I so much desired.
+
+For the remainder of the day, I went out walking in their gardens, which
+were filled with squashes, beans, and our peas, which they were beginning
+to cultivate, when Thomas, my interpreter, who understands the language
+very well, came to inform me that the savages, after I had left them, had
+come to the conclusion, that if I were to undertake this journey I should
+die and they also, and that they could not furnish the promised canoes, as
+there was no one of them who would guide me, but that they wished me to
+postpone the journey until the next year, when they would conduct me with a
+good train to protect me from that people, in case they should attempt to
+harm me, as they are evil-disposed.
+
+This intelligence greatly disturbed me, and I at once went to them and told
+them, that up to this day I had regarded them as men and truthful persons,
+but that now they had shown themselves children and liars, and that if they
+would not fulfil their promises, they would fail to show me their
+friendship; that, however, if they felt it an inconvenience to give me four
+canoes they should only furnish two and four savages.
+
+They represented to me anew the difficulties attending the journey, the
+number of the falls, the bad character of the people, and that their reason
+for refusing my request was their fear of losing me.
+
+I replied that I was sorry to have them show themselves to so slight an
+extent my friends, and that I should never have believed it; that I had a
+young man, showing them my impostor, who had been in their country, and had
+not found all these difficulties which they represented, nor the people in
+question so bad as they asserted. Then they began to look at him, in
+particular Tessoueat the old captain, with whom he had passed the winter,
+and calling him by name he said to him in his language: Nicholas, is it
+true that you said you were among the Nebicerini? It was long before he
+spoke, when he said to them in their language, which he spoke to a certain
+extent: Yes, I was there. They immediately looked at him awry, and throwing
+themselves upon him, as if they would eat him up or tear him in pieces,
+raised loud cries, when Tessoueat said to him: You are a downright liar, you
+know well that you slept at my side every night with my children, where you
+arose every morning; if you were among the people mentioned, it was while
+sleeping. How could you have been so bold as to lead your chief to believe
+lies, and so wicked as to be willing to expose his life to so many dangers?
+You are a worthless fellow, and he ought to put you to death more cruelly
+than we do our enemies. I am not astonished that he should so importune us
+on the assurance of your words.
+
+I at once told him that he must reply to these people; and since he had
+been in the regions indicated, that he must give me proofs of it, and free
+me from the suspense in which he had placed me. But he remained silent and
+greatly terrified.
+
+I immediately withdrew him from the savages, and conjured him to declare
+the truth of the matter, telling him that, if he had seen the sea in
+question, I would give him the reward which I had promised him, and that,
+if he had not seen it, he must tell me so without causing me farther
+trouble. Again he affirmed with oaths all he had before said, and that he
+would demonstrate to me the truth of it, if the savages would give us
+canoes.
+
+Upon this, Thomas came and informed me, that the savages of the island had
+secretly sent a canoe to the Nebicerini, to notify them of my arrival.
+Thereupon, in order to profit by the opportunity, I went to the savages to
+tell them, that I had dreamed the past night that they purposed to send a
+canoe to the Nebicerini without notifying me of it, at which I was greatly
+surprised, since they knew that I was desirous of going there. Upon which
+they replied that I did them a great wrong in trusting a liar, who wanted
+to cause my death, more than so many brave chiefs, who were my friends and
+who held my life dear. I replied that my man, meaning our impostor, had
+been in the aforesaid country with one of the relatives of Tessoueat and had
+seen the sea, the wreck and ruins of an English vessel, together with
+eighty scalps which the savages had in their possession, and a young
+English boy whom they held as prisoner, and whom they wished to give me as
+a present.
+
+When they heard me speak of the sea, vessels, scalps of the English, and
+the young prisoner, they cried out more than before that he was a liar, and
+thus they afterwards called him, as if it were the greatest insult they
+could have done him, and they all united in saying that he ought to be put
+to death, or else that he should tell with whom he had gone to the place
+indicated, and state the lakes, rivers, and roads, by which he had gone. To
+this he replied with assurance, that he had forgotten the name of the
+savage, although he had stated to me his name more than twenty times, and
+even on the previous day. In respect to the peculiarities of the country,
+he had described them in a paper which he had handed me. Then I brought
+forward the map and had it explained to the savages, who questioned him in
+regard to it. To this he made no reply, but rather manifested by his sullen
+silence his perverse nature.
+
+As my mind was wavering in uncertainty, I withdrew by myself, and reflected
+upon the above-mentioned particulars of the voyage of the English, and how
+the reports of our liar were quite in conformity with it, also that there
+was little probability of this young man's having invented all that, in
+which case he would not have been willing to undertake the journey, but
+that it was more probable that he had seen these things, and that his
+ignorance did not permit him to reply to the questions of the savages. To
+the above is to be added the fact that, if the report of the English be
+true, the North Sea cannot be farther distant from this region than a
+hundred leagues in latitude, for I was in latitude 47 deg. and in longitude
+296 deg..[71] But it may be that the difficulties attending the passage of the
+falls, the roughness of the mountains covered with shows, is the reason why
+this people have no knowledge of the sea in question; indeed they have
+always said that from the country of the Ochateguins it is a journey of
+thirty-five or forty days to the sea, which they see in three places, a
+thing which they have again assured me of this year. But no one has spoken
+to me of this sea on the north, except this liar, who had given me thereby
+great pleasure in view of the shortness of the journey.
+
+Now, when this canoe was ready, I had him summoned into the presence of his
+companions; and after laying before him all that had transpired, I told him
+that any further dissimulation was out of the question, and that he must
+say whether he had seen these things or not; that I was desirous of
+improving the opportunity that presented itself; that I had forgotten the
+past; but that, if I went farther, I would have him hung and strangled,
+which should be his sole reward. After meditating by himself, he fell on
+his knees and asked my pardon, declaring that all he had said, both in
+France and this country, in respect to the sea in question was false; that
+he had never seen it, and that he had never gone farther than the village
+of Tessoueat; that he had said these things in order to return to Canada.
+Overcome with wrath at this, I had him removed, being unable to endure him
+any longer in my presence, and giving orders to Thomas to inquire into the
+whole matter in detail; to whom he stated, that he did not believe that I
+would undertake the journey on account of the dangers, thinking that some
+difficulty would present itself to prevent me from going on, as in the case
+of these savages, who were not disposed to lend me canoes; and accordingly
+that the journey would be put off until another year, when he being in
+France would be rewarded for his discovery; but that, if I would leave him
+in this country, he would go until he found the sea in question, even if he
+should die in the attempt. These were his words as reported to me by
+Thomas, but they did not give me much satisfaction, astounded as I was at
+the effrontery and maliciousness of this liar: and I cannot imagine how he
+could have devised this imposition, unless that he had heard of the
+above-mentioned voyage of the English, and in the hope of some reward, as
+he said, had the temerity to venture on it.
+
+Shortly after I proceeded to notify the savages, to my great regret, of the
+malignity of this liar, stating that he had confessed the truth; at which
+they were delighted, reproaching me with the little confidence I put in
+them, who were chiefs and my friends, and who always spoke the truth; and
+who said that this liar ought to be put to death, being extremely
+malicious; and they added, Do you not see that he meant to cause your
+death. Give him to us, and we promise you that he shall not lie any more.
+And as they all went after him shouting, their children also shouting still
+more, I forbade them to do him any harm, directing them to keep their
+children also from doing so, inasmuch as I wished to take him to the Falls
+to show him to the gentlemen there, to whom he was to bring some salt
+water; and I said that, when I arrived there, I would consult as to what
+should be done with him.
+
+My journey having been in this manner terminated, and without any hope of
+seeing the sea in this direction, except in imagination, I felt a regret
+that I should not have employed my time better, and that I should have had
+to endure the difficulties and hardships, which however I was obliged
+patiently to submit to. If I had gone in another direction, according to
+the report of the savages, I should have made a beginning in a thing which
+must be postponed to another time. At present my only wish being to return,
+I desired the savages to go to the Falls of St. Louis, where there were
+four vessels loaded with all kinds of merchandise, and where they would be
+well treated. This they communicated to all their neighbors. Before setting
+out, I made a cross of white cedar, which I planted in a prominent place on
+the border of the lake, with the arms of France, and I begged the savages
+to have the kindness to preserve it, as also those which they would find
+along the ways we had passed; telling them that, if they broke them,
+misfortune would befall them, but that, if they preserved them, they would
+not be assaulted by their enemies. They promised to do so, and said that I
+should find them when I came to visit them again.
+
+ENDNOTES:
+
+65. It seems not improbable, as suggested by Laverdiere, that this was the
+ same chief that Champlain met at Tadoussac in 1603, then called
+ _Besouat. Vide_ Vol. I. p. 242.
+
+66. They crossed Muskrat Lake, and after a portage of a league, by general
+ estimation, they reached Lake Allumette. This lake is only the expanded
+ current of the river Ottawa on the southern side of Allumette Island;
+ which is formed by the bifurcation of the Ottawa.
+
+67. Allumette Island, often called, in the _Relations des Jesuites_, simply
+ the Island. The savages in occupation were in the habit of exacting
+ tribute from the Hurons and others, who passed along on their war
+ excursions or their journeys for trade with the French at Montreal.
+ They bartered their maize with other tribes for skins with which they
+ clothed themselves.
+
+68. The true latitude here is about 45 deg. 47'. On the map of 1632 the
+ latitude corresponds with the statement in the text.
+
+69. In his issue of 1632 Champlain corrects his statement as to the length
+ of Allumette Island, and says it is ten leagues long, which is nearly
+ correct. _Vide_ Quebec ed. p 868. Of this island Bouchette says that in
+ length it is about fifteen miles, and on an average four miles wide.
+ _British Dominions in North America_, London, 1831, Vol I. p. 187.
+
+70. This tribe was subsequently known as the Nipissings, who dwelt on the
+ borders of Lake Nipissing. They were distinguished for their sorceries,
+ under the cover of which they appear to have practised impositions
+ which naturally enough rendered other neighboring Algonquin tribes
+ hostile to them.
+
+71. The true latitude, as we have stated, _antea_, note 61, is about 45 deg.
+ 37'; but on Champlain's map it corresponds with the statement in the
+ text, and a hundred leagues north of where they then were, as his map
+ is constructed, would carry them to the place in the bay where Hudson
+ wintered, as stated by Champlain, and as laid down on his small map
+ included in this volume; but the longitude is incorrect, Allumette
+ Island being two or three degrees east of longitude 296 deg., as laid down
+ on Champlain's map of 1632.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER V.
+
+OUR RETURN TO THE FALLS.--FALSE ALARM.--CEREMONY AT THE CHAUDIERE FALLS.--
+CONFESSION OF OUR LIAR BEFORE ALL THE CHIEF MEN.--OUR RETURN TO FRANCE.
+
+On the 10th of June I took leave of Tessoueat, a good old captain, making
+him presents, and promising him, if God preserved me in health, to come the
+next year, prepared to go to war. He in turn promised to assemble a large
+number by that time, declaring that I should see nothing but savages and
+arms which would please me; he also directed his son to go with me for the
+sake of company. Thus we set out with forty canoes, and passed by way [72]
+of the river we had left, which extends northward, and where we went on
+shore in order to cross the lakes. On the way we met nine large canoes of
+the Ouescharini, with forty strong and powerful men, who had come upon the
+news they had received; we also met others, making all together sixty
+canoes; and we overtook twenty others, who had set out before us, each
+heavily laden with merchandise.
+
+We passed six or seven falls between the island of the Algonquins [73] and
+the little fall, [74] where the country was very unpleasant I readily
+realized that, if we had gone in that direction, we should have had much
+more trouble, and would with difficulty have succeeded in getting through:
+and it was not without reason that the savages opposed our liar, as his
+only object was to cause my ruin.
+
+Continuing our course ten or twelve leagues below the island of the
+Algonquins, we rested on a very pleasant island, which was covered with
+vines and nut-trees, and where we caught some fine fish. About midnight,
+there arrived two canoes, which had been fishing farther off, and which
+reported that they had seen four canoes of their enemies. At once three
+canoes were despatched to reconnoitre, but they returned without having
+seen anything. With this assurance all gave themselves up to sleep,
+excepting the women, who resolved to spend the night in their canoes, not
+feeling at ease on land. An hour before daylight a savage, having dreamed
+that the enemy were attacking them, jumped up and started on a run towards
+the water, in order to escape, shouting, They are killing me. Those
+belonging to his band all awoke dumfounded and, supposing that they were
+being pursued by their enemies, threw themselves into the water, as did
+also one of our Frenchmen, who supposed that they were being overpowered.
+At this great noise, the rest of us, who were at a distance, were at once
+awakened, and without making farther investigation ran towards them: but as
+we saw them here and there in the water, we were greatly surprised, not
+seeing them pursued by their enemies, nor in a state of defence, in case of
+necessity, but only ready to sacrifice themselves. After I had inquired of
+our Frenchman about the cause of this excitement, he told me that a savage
+had had a dream, and that he with the rest had thrown themselves into the
+water in order to escape, supposing that they were being attacked.
+Accordingly, the state of the case being ascertained, it all passed off in
+a laugh.
+
+Continuing our way, we came to the Chaudiere Falls, where the savages went
+through with the customary ceremony; which is as follows. After carrying
+their canoes to the foot of the Fall, they assemble in one spot, where one
+of them takes up a collection with a wooden plate, into which each one puts
+a bit of tobacco. The collection having been made, the plate is placed in
+the midst of the troupe, and all dance about it, singing after their style.
+Then one of the captains makes an harangue, setting forth that for a long
+time they have been accustomed to make this offering, by which means they
+are insured protection against their enemies, that otherwise misfortune
+would befall them, as they are convinced by the evil spirit; and they live
+on in this superstition, as in many others, as we have said in other
+places. This done, the maker of the harangue takes the plate, and throws
+the tobacco into the midst of the caldron, whereupon they all together
+raise a loud cry. These poor people are so superstitious, that they would
+not believe it possible for them to make a prosperous journey without
+observing this ceremony at this place, since their enemies await them at
+this portage, not venturing to go any farther on account of the difficulty
+of the journey, whence they say they surprise them there, as they have
+sometimes done.
+
+The next day we arrived at an island at the entrance to a lake, and seven
+or eight leagues distant from the great Falls of St. Louis. Here while
+reposing at night we had another alarm, the savages supposing that they had
+seen the canoes of their enemies. This led them to make several large
+fires, which I had them put out, representing to them the harm which might
+result, namely, that instead of concealing they would disclose themselves.
+
+On the 17th of June, we arrived at the Falls of St. Louis, where I found
+L'Ange, who had come to meet me in a canoe to inform me, that Sieur de
+Maisonneuve of St. Malo had brought a passport from the Prince for three
+vessels. In order to arrange matters until I should see him, I assembled
+all the savages and informed them that I did not wish them to traffic in
+any merchandise until I had given them permission, and that I would furnish
+them provisions as soon as we should arrive; which they promised, saying
+that they were my friends. Thus, continuing our course, we arrived at the
+barques, where we were saluted by some discharges of cannon, at which some
+of our savages were delighted, and others greatly astonished, never having
+heard such music. After I had landed, Maisonneuve came to me with the
+passport of the Prince. As soon as I had seen it, I allowed him and his men
+to enjoy the benefits of it like the rest of us; and I sent word to the
+savages that they might trade on the next day.
+
+After seeing all the chief men and relating the particulars of my journey
+and the malice of my liar, at which they were greatly amazed, I begged them
+to assemble, in order that in their presence, and that of the savages and
+his companions, he might make declaration of his maliciousness; which they
+gladly did. Being thus assembled, they summoned him, and asked him, why he
+had not shown me the sea in the north, as he had promised me at his
+departure. He replied that he had promised something impossible for him,
+since he had never seen this sea, and that the desire of making the journey
+had led him to say what he did, also that he did not suppose that I would
+undertake it; and he begged them to be pleased to pardon him, as he also
+did me again, confessing that he had greatly offended, and if I would leave
+him in the country, he would by his efforts repair the offence, and see
+this sea, and bring back trustworthy intelligence concerning it the
+following year; and in view of certain considerations I pardoned him on
+this condition.
+
+After relating to them in detail the good treatment I had received at the
+abodes of the savages, and how I had been occupied each day, I inquired
+what they had done during my absence, and what had been the result of their
+hunting excursions, and they said they had had such success that they
+generally brought home six stags. Once on St. Barnabas's day, Sieur du
+Parc, having gone hunting with two others, killed nine. These stags are not
+at all like ours, and there are different kinds of them, some larger,
+others smaller, which resemble closely our deer.[75] They had also a very
+large number of pigeons, [76] and also fish, such as pike, carp, sturgeon,
+shad, barbel, turtles, bass, and other kinds unknown to us, on which they
+dined and supped every day. They were also all in better condition than
+myself, who was reduced from work and the anxiety which I had experienced,
+not having eaten more than once a day, and that of fish badly cooked and
+half broiled.
+
+On the 22d of June, about 8 o'clock in the evening, the savages sounded an
+alarm because one of them had dreamed he had seen the Iroquois. In order to
+content them, all the men took their arms, and some were sent to their
+cabins to reassure them, and into the approaches to reconnoitre, so that,
+finding it was a false alarm, they were satisfied with the firing of some
+two hundred musket and arquebus shots, after which arms were laid down, the
+ordinary guard only being left. This reassured them greatly, and they were
+very glad to see the French ready to help them.
+
+After the savages had bartered their articles of merchandise and had
+resolved to return, I asked them to take with them two young men, to treat
+them in a friendly manner, show them the country, and bind themselves to
+bring them back. But they strongly objected to this, representing to me the
+trouble our liar had given me, and fearing that they would bring me false
+reports, as he had done. I replied that they were men of probity and truth,
+and that if they would not take them they were not my friends, whereupon
+they resolved to do so. As for out liar, none of the savages wanted him,
+notwithstanding my request to them to take him, and we left him to the
+mercy of God.
+
+Finding that I had no further, business in this country, I resolved to
+cross in the first vessel that should return to France. Sieur de
+Maisonneuve, having his ready, offered me a passage, which I accepted; and
+on the 27th of June I set out with Sieur L'Ange from the Falls, where we
+left the other vessels, which were awaiting the return of the savages who
+had gone to the war, and we arrived at Tadoussac on the 6th of July.
+
+On the 8th of August [77] we were enabled by favorable weather to set
+sail. On the 18th we left Gaspe and Isle Percee. On the 28th we were on the
+Grand Bank, where the green fishery is carried on, and where we took as
+many fish as we wanted.
+
+On the 26th of August we arrived at St Malo, where I saw the merchants, to
+whom I represented the ease of forming a good association in the future,
+which they resolved to do, as those of Rouen and La Rochelle had done,
+after recognizing the necessity of the regulations, without which it is
+impossible to hope for any profit from these lands. May God by His grace
+cause this undertaking to prosper to His honor and glory, the conversion of
+these poor benighted ones, and to the welfare and honor of France.
+
+ENDNOTES:
+
+72. By the Ottawa, which they had left a little below Portage du Fort, and
+ not by the same way they had come, through the system of small lakes,
+ of which Muskrat lake is one. _Vide Carte de la Nouvelle France_, 1632,
+ Vol. I. p. 304.
+
+73. Allumette Island.
+
+74. Near Gould's Landing, below or south of Portage da Fort.--_Vide
+ Champlain's Astrolabe_, by A. J. Russell, Montreal, 1879, p. 6.
+
+75. At that time there were to be found in Canada at least four species of
+ the Cervus Family.
+
+ 1. The Moose, _Cervus alces_, or _alces Americanus_, usually called by
+ the earliest writers _orignal_ or _orignac_. _Vide_ Vol. I. pp. 264,
+ 265. This is the largest of all the deer family in this or in any other
+ part of the world The average weight has been placed at seven hundred
+ pounds, while extraordinary specimens probably attain twice that
+ weight.
+
+ 2. The Wapiti, or American Elk, _Cervus elaphus_, or _Canadensis_. This
+ is the largest of the known deer except the preceding. The average
+ weight is probably less than six hundred pounds.
+
+ 3. The Woodland Caribou, _Cervus tarandus_. It is smaller than the
+ Wapiti. Its range is now mostly in the northern regions of the
+ continent but specimens are still found in Nova Scotia and New
+ Brunswick. The female is armed with antlers as well as the male, though
+ they are smaller.
+
+ 4. The Common Deer, _Cervus Virginianus_. It has the widest range of
+ any of the deer family. It is still found in every degree of latitude
+ from Mexico to British Columbia. _Vide Antelope and Deer of America_ by
+ John Dean Caton, LL.D., Boston, 1877.
+
+76. _Palombes_. The passenger, or wild pigeon, _Ectopistes migratorius_.
+
+77. _Le_ 8 _Aoust_. Laverdiere suggests with much plausibility that this
+ should read "The 8th of July." Champlain could hardly have found it
+ necessary to remain at Tadoussac from the 6th of July to the 8th of
+ August for favorable weather to sail. If he had been detained by any
+ other cause, it would probably nave been deemed of sufficient gravity
+ to be specially mentioned.
+
+
+
+VOYAGES
+AND
+DISCOVERIES IN NEW FRANCE,
+From the year 1615 to the end of the year 1618.
+
+BY
+SIEUR DE CHAMPLAIN,
+Captain in ordinary to the King in the Western Sea.
+
+WHERE ARE DESCRIBED
+
+_The manners, customs, dress, mode of warfare, hunting, dances, festivals,
+and method of burial of various savage peoples, with many remarkable
+experiences of the author in this country, and an account of the beauty,
+fertility, and temperature of the same.
+
+PARIS.
+
+CLAUDE COLLET, in the Palace, at the gallery of the Prisoners.
+
+M. DC. XIX.
+
+_WITH AUTHORITY OF THE KING_.
+
+
+TO THE KING.
+
+_Sire, This is a third volume containing a narrative of what has transpired
+most worthy of note during the voyages I have made to New France, and its
+perusal will, I think, afford your Majesty greater pleasure than that of
+those preceding, which only designate the ports, harbors, situations,
+declinations, and other particulars, having more interest for navigators
+and sailors than for other persons. In this narrative you will be able to
+observe more especially the manners and mode of life of these peoples both
+in particular and in general, their wars, ammunition, method of attack and
+of defence, their expeditions and retreats in various circumstances,
+matters about which those interested desire information. You will perceive
+also that they are not savage to such an extent that they could not in
+course of time and through association with others become civilised and
+cultivated. You will likewise perceive how great hopes we cherish from the
+long and arduous labors we have for the past fifteen years sustained, in
+order to plant in this country the standard of the cross, and to teach the
+people the knowledge of God and the glory of His holy name, it being our
+desire to cultivate a feeling of charity towards His unfortunate creatures,
+which it is our duty to practise more patiently than any other thing,
+especially as there are many who have not entertained such purposes, but
+have been influenced only by the desire of gain. Nevertheless we may, I
+suppose, believe that these are the means which God makes use of for the
+greater promotion of the holy desire of others. As the fruits which the
+trees bear are from God, the Lord of the soil, who has planted, watered,
+and nourished them with an especial care, so your Majesty can be called the
+legitimate lord of our labors, and the good resulting from them, not only
+because the land belongs to you, but also because you have protected us
+against so many persons, whose only object has been by troubling us to
+prevent the success of so holy a determination, taking from us the power to
+trade freely in apart of your country, and striving to bring everything
+into confusion, which would be, in a word, preparing the way for the ruin
+of everything to the injury of your state. To this end your subjects have
+employed every conceivable artifice and all possible means which they
+thought could injure us. But all these efforts have been thwarted by your
+Majesty, assisted by your prudent council, who have given us the authority
+of your name, and supported us by your decrees rendered in our favor. This
+is an occasion for increasing in us our long-cherished desire to send
+communities and colonies there, to teach the people the knowledge of God,
+and inform them of the glory and triumphs of your Majesty, so that together
+with the French language they may also acquire a French heart and spirit,
+which, next to the fear of God, will be inspired with nothing so ardently
+as the desire to serve you. Should our design succeed, the glory of it will
+be due, after God, to your Majesty, who will receive a thousand
+benedictions from Heaven for so many souls saved by your instrumentality,
+and your name will be immortalized for carrying the glory and sceptre of
+the French as far to the Occident as your precursors have extended it to
+the Orient, and over the entire habitable earth. This will augment the
+quality of_ MOST CHRISTIAN _belonging to you above all the kings of the
+earth, and show that it is as much your due by merit as it is your own of
+right, it having been transmitted to you by your predecessors, who acquired
+it by their virtues; for you have been pleased, in addition to so many
+other important affairs, to give your attention to this one, so seriously
+neglected hitherto, God's special grace reserving to your reign the
+publication of His gospel, and the knowledge of His holy name to so many
+tribes who had never heard of it. And some day may God's grace lead them,
+as it does us, to pray to Him without ceasing to extend your empire, and to
+vouchsafe a thousand blessings to your Majesty_.
+
+_SIRE_,
+
+_Your most humble, most faithful_,
+
+_and most obedient servant and subject_,
+
+_CHAMPLAIN_.
+
+
+
+
+PREFACE.
+
+
+As in the various affairs of the world each thing strives for its
+perfection and the preservation of its being, so on the other hand does man
+interest himself in the different concerns of others on some account,
+either for the public good, or to acquire, apart from the common interest,
+praise and reputation with some profit. Wherefore many have pursued this
+course, but as for myself I have made choice of the most unpleasant and
+difficult one of the perilous navigation of the seas; with the purpose,
+however, not so much of gaining wealth, as the honor and glory of God in
+behalf of my King and country, and contributing by my labors something
+useful to the public good. And I make declaration that I have not been
+tempted by any other ambition, as can be clearly perceived, not only by my
+conduct in the past, but also by the narratives of my voyages, made by the
+command of His Majesty, in New France, contained in my first and second
+books, as may be seen in the same.
+
+Should God bless our purpose, which aims only for His glory, and should any
+fruit result from our discoveries and arduous labors, I will return thanks
+to Him, and for Your Majesty's protection and assistance will continue my
+prayers for the aggrandizement and prolongation of your reign.
+
+
+
+
+EXTRACT FROM THE LICENSE OF THE KING.
+
+By favor and license of the KING, permission is given to CLAUDE COLLET,
+merchant bookseller in our city of Paris, to print, or have printed by such
+printer as shall seem good to him, a book entitled, _Voyages and
+Discoveries in New France, from the Year_ 1615 _to the End of the Year
+1618. By Sieur de Champlain, Captain in Ordinary to the King in the Western
+Sea_. All booksellers and printers of our kingdom are forbidden to print or
+have printed, to sell wholesale or retail, said book, except with the
+consent of said Collet, for the time and term of six years, beginning with
+the day when said book is printed, on penalty of confiscation of the
+copies, and a fine of four hundred _livres_, a half to go to us and a half
+to said petitioner. It is our will, moreover, that this License should be
+placed at the commencement or end of said book. This is our pleasure.
+
+Given at Paris, the 18th day of May, 1619, and of our reign the tenth.
+
+By the Council,
+
+DE CESCAUD
+
+
+
+
+VOYAGE
+OF
+SIEUR DE CHAMPLAIN TO NEW FRANCE,
+MADE IN THE YEAR 1615.
+
+
+The strong love, which I have always cherished for the exploration of New
+France, has made me desirous of extending more and more my travels over the
+country, in order, by means of its numerous rivers, lakes, and streams, to
+obtain at last a complete knowledge of it, and also to become acquainted
+with the inhabitants, with the view of bringing them to the knowledge of
+God. To this end I have toiled constantly for the past fourteen or fifteen
+years, [78] yet have been able to advance my designs but little, because I
+have not received the assistance which was necessary for the success of
+such an undertaking. Nevertheless, without losing courage, I have not
+ceased to push on, and visit various nations of the savages; and, by
+associating familiarly with them, I have concluded, as well from their
+conversation as from the knowledge already attained, that there is no
+better way than, disregarding all storms and difficulties, to have patience
+until His Majesty shall give the requisite attention to the matter, and
+meanwhile, not only to continue the exploration of the country, but also to
+learn the language, and form relations and friendships with the leading men
+of the villages and tribes, in order to lay the foundations of a permanent
+edifice, as well for the glory of God as for the renown of the French.
+
+And His Majesty having transferred and intrusted the superintendence of
+this work to Monseigneur the Prince de Conde, the latter has, by his
+management, under the authority of His Majesty, sustained us against all
+forts of jealousies and obstacles concerted by evil wishers. This has, as
+it were, animated me and redoubled my courage for the continuation of my
+labors in the exploration of New France, and with increased effort I have
+pushed forward in my undertaking into the mainland, and farther on than I
+had previously been, as will be hereafter indicated in the course of this
+narrative.
+
+But it is appropriate to state first that, as I had observed in my previous
+journeys, there were in some places people permanently settled, who were
+fond of the cultivation of the soil, but who had neither faith nor law, and
+lived without God and religion, like brute beasts. In view of this, I felt
+convinced that I should be committing a grave offence if I did not take it
+upon myself to devise some means of bringing them to the knowledge of
+God. To this end I exerted myself to find some good friars, with zeal and
+affection for the glory of God, that I might persuade them to send some
+one, or go themselves, with me to these countries, and try to plant there
+the faith, or at least do what was possible according to their calling, and
+thus to observe and ascertain whether any good fruit could be gathered
+there. But since to attain this object an expenditure would be required
+exceeding my means, and for other reasons, I deferred the matter for a
+while, in view of the difficulties there would be in obtaining what was
+necessary and requisite in such an enterprise; and since, furthermore, no
+persons offered to contribute to it. Nevertheless, while continuing my
+search, and communicating my plan to various persons, a man of distinction
+chanced to present himself, whose intimate acquaintance I enjoyed. This was
+Sieur Houeel, Secretary of the King and Controller-general of the salt works
+at Brouage, a man of devoted piety, and of great zeal and love for the
+honor of God and the extension of His religion. [79] He gave me the
+following information, which afforded me great pleasure. He said that he
+was acquainted with some good religious Fathers, of the order of the
+Recollects, in whom he had confidence; and that he enjoyed such intimacy
+and confidence with them that he could easily induce them to consent to
+undertake the voyage; and that, as to the necessary means for sending out
+three or four friars, there would be no lack of people of property who
+would give them what they needed, offering for his part to assist them to
+the extent of his ability; and, in fact, he wrote in relation to the
+subject to Father du Verger, [80] who welcomed with joy the undertaking,
+and, in accordance with the recommendation of Sieur Houeel, communicated it
+to some of his brethren, who, burning with charity, offered themselves
+freely for this holy undertaking.
+
+Now he was at that time in Saintonge, whence he sent two men to Paris with
+a commission, though not with absolute power, reserving the rest to the
+Nuncio of our Holy Father the Pope, who was at that time, in 1614, in
+France. [81] He called upon these friars at their house in Paris, and was
+greatly pleased with their resolution. We then went all together to see the
+Sieur Nuncio, in order to communicate to him the commission, and entreat
+him to interpose his authority in the matter. But he, on the contrary, told
+us that he had no power whatever in such matters, and that it was to their
+General that they were to address themselves. Notwithstanding this reply,
+the Recollects, in consideration of the difficulty of the mission, were
+unwilling to undertake the journey on the authority of Father du Verger,
+fearing that it might not be sufficient, and that the commission might not
+be valid, on which account the matter was postponed to the following
+year. Meanwhile they took counsel, and came to a determination, according
+to which all arrangements were made for the undertaking, which was to be
+carried out in the following spring; awaiting which the two friars returned
+to their convent at Brouage.
+
+I for my part improved the time in arranging my affairs in preparation for
+the voyage.
+
+Some months after the departure of the two friars, the Reverend Father
+Chapouein, Provincial of the Recollect Fathers, a man of great piety,
+returned to Paris. Sieur, Houeel called on him, and narrated what had taken
+place respecting the authority of Father du Verger, and the mission he had
+given to the Recollect Fathers. After which narrative the Provincial Father
+proceeded to extol the plan, and to interest himself with zeal in it,
+promising to promote it with all his power, and adding that, he had not
+before well comprehended the subject of this mission; and it is to be
+believed that God inspired him more and more to prosecute the matter.
+Subsequently he spoke of it to Monseigneur the Prince de Conde, and to all
+the cardinals and bishops who were then assembled at Paris for the Session
+of the Estates. All of them approved and commended the plan; and to show
+that they were favorably disposed towards it, they assured the Sieur
+Provincial that they would devise among themselves and the members of the
+Court means for raising a small fund, and that they would collect some
+money for assisting four friars to be chosen, and who were then chosen for
+the execution of so holy a work. And in order to facilitate the
+undertaking, I visited at the Estates the cardinals and bishops, and
+urgently represented to them the advantage, and usefulness which might one
+day result, in order by my entreaties to move them to give, and cause
+others who might be stimulated by their example to give, contributions and
+presents, leaving all to their good will and judgment.
+
+The contributions which were made for the expenses of this expedition
+amounted to nearly fifteen hundred _livres_, which were put into my hands,
+and then employed, according to the advice and in the presence of the
+Fathers, for the purchase of what was necessary, not only for the
+maintenance of the Fathers who should undertake the journey into New
+France, but also for their clothing, and the attire and ornaments necessary
+for performing divine service. The friars were sent on in advance to
+Honfleur, where their embarkation was to take place.
+
+Now the Fathers who were appointed for this holy enterprise were Father
+Denis [82] as commissary, Jean d'Olbeau, [83] Joseph le Caron, and
+Pacifique du Plessis, [84] each of whom was moved by a holy zeal and ardor
+to make the journey, through God's grace, in order to see if they might
+produce some good fruit, and plant in these regions the standard of Jesus
+Christ, determined to live and to die for His holy name, should it be
+necessary to do so and the occasion require it. Everything having been
+prepared, they provided themselves with church ornaments, and we with what
+was necessary for our voyage.
+
+I left Paris the last day of February to meet at Rouen our associates, and
+represent to them the will of Monseigneur the Prince, and also his desire
+that these good Fathers should make the journey, since he recognized the
+fact that the affairs of the country could hardly reach any perfection or
+advancement, if God should not first of all be served; with which our
+associates were highly pleased, promising to assist the Fathers to the
+extent of their ability, and provide them with the support they might need.
+
+The Fathers arrived at Rouen the twentieth of March following, where we
+stayed some time. Thence we went to Honfleur to embark, where we also
+stayed some days, waiting for our vessel to be got ready, and loaded with
+the necessaries for so long a voyage. Meanwhile preparations were made in
+matters of conscience, so that each one of us might examine himself, and
+cleanse himself from his sins by penitence and confession, in order to
+celebrate the sacrament and attain a state of grace, so that, being thereby
+freer in conscience, we might under the guidance of God, expose ourselves
+to the mercy of the waves of the great and perilous sea.
+
+This done, we embarked on the vessel of the association, which was of three
+hundred and fifty tons burden, and was called the Saint Etienne, commanded
+by Sieur de Pont Grave. We departed from Honfleur on the twenty-fourth day
+of August, [85] in the above-mentioned year, and set sail with a very
+favorable wind. We continued on our voyage without encountering ice or
+other dangers, through the mercy of God, and in a short time arrived off
+the place called _Tadoussac_, on the twenty-fifth day of May, when we
+rendered thanks to God for having conducted us so favorably to the harbor
+of our destination.
+
+Then we began to set men at work to fit up our barques in order to go to
+Quebec, the place of our abode, and to the great Falls of Saint Louis, the
+rendezvous of the savages, who come there to traffic.
+
+The barques having been fitted up, we went on board with the Fathers, one
+of whom, named Father Joseph, [86] desired, without stopping or making any
+stay at Quebec, to go directly to the great Falls, where he saw all the
+savages and their mode of life. This induced him to go and spend the winter
+in their country and that of other tribes who have a fixed abode, not only
+in order to learn their language, but also to see what the prospect was of
+their conversion to Christianity. This resolution having been formed, he
+returned to Quebec the twentieth day of June [87] for some church ornaments
+and other necessaries. Meanwhile I had stayed at Quebec in order to arrange
+matters relating to our habitation, as the lodgings of the Fathers, church
+ornaments, the construction of a chapel for the celebration of the mass, as
+also the employment of persons for clearing up lands. I embarked for the
+Falls together with Father Denis, [88] who had arrived the same day from
+Tadoussac with Sieur de Pont Grave.
+
+As to the other friars, viz., Fathers Jean and Pacifique, [89] they stayed
+at Quebec in order to fit up their chapel and arrange their lodgings. They
+were greatly pleased at seeing the place so different from what they had
+imagined, which increased their zeal.
+
+We arrived at the Riviere des Prairies, five leagues below the Falls of
+Saint Louis, whither the savages had come down. I will not attempt to speak
+of the pleasure which our Fathers experienced at seeing, not only so long
+and large a river, filled with many fine islands and bordered by a region
+apparently so fertile, but also a great number of strong and robust men,
+with natures not so savage as their manners, nor as they acknowledged they
+had conceived them to be, and very different from what they had been given
+to understand, owing to their lack of cultivation. I will not enter into a
+description of them, but refer the reader to what I have said about them in
+my preceding books, printed in the year 1614. [90]
+
+To continue my narrative: We met Father Joseph, who was returning to Quebec
+in order to make preparations, and take what he needed for wintering in
+their country. This I did not think advisable at this season, but
+counselled him rather to spend the winter at our settlement as being more
+for his comfort, and undertake the journey when spring came or at least in
+summer, offering to accompany him, and adding that by doing so he would not
+fail to see what he might have seen by going, and that by returning and
+spending the winter at Quebec he would have the society of his brothers and
+others who remained at the settlement, by which he would be more profited
+than by staying alone among these people, with whom he could not, in my
+opinion, have much satisfaction. Nevertheless, in spite of all that could
+be said to him and all representations, he would not change his purpose,
+being urged by a godly zeal and love for this people, and hoping to make
+known to them their salvation.
+
+His motive in undertaking this enterprise, as he stated to us, was that he
+thought it was necessary for him to go there not only in order to become
+better acquainted with the characteristics of the people, but also to learn
+more easily their language. In regard to the difficulties which it was
+represented to him that he would have to encounter in his intercourse with
+them, he felt assured that he could bear and overcome them, and that he
+could adapt himself very well and cheerfully to the manner of living and
+the inconveniences he would find, through the grace of God, of whose
+goodness and help he felt clearly assured, being convinced that, since he
+went on His service, and since it was for the glory of His name and the
+preaching of His holy gospel that he undertook freely this journey, He
+would never abandon him in his undertaking. And in regard to temporal
+provisions very little was needed to satisfy a man who demands nothing but
+perpetual poverty, and who seeks for nothing but heaven, not only for
+himself but also for his brethren, it not being consistent with his rule of
+life to have any other ambition than the glory of God, and it being his
+purpose to endure to this end all the hardships, sufferings, and labors
+which might offer.
+
+Seeing him impelled by so holy a zeal and so ardent a charity, I was
+unwilling to try any more to restrain him. Thus he set out with the purpose
+of being the first to announce through His holy favor to this people the
+name of God, having the great satisfaction that an opportunity presented
+itself for suffering something for the name and glory of our Saviour Jesus
+Christ.
+
+As soon as I had arrived at the Falls, I visited the people, who were very
+desirous of seeing us and delighted at our return. They hoped that we would
+furnish them some of our number to assist them in their wars against our
+enemies, representing to us that they could with difficulty come to us if
+we should not assist them; for the Iroquois, they said, their old enemies,
+were always on the road obstructing their passage. Moreover I had
+constantly promised to assist them in their wars, as they gave us to
+understand by their interpreter. Whereupon Sieur Pont Grave and myself
+concluded that it was very necessary to assist them, not only in order to
+put them the more under obligations to love us, but also to facilitate my
+undertakings and explorations which, as it seemed, could only be
+accomplished by their help, and also as this would be a preparatory step to
+their conversion to Christianity. [91] Therefore I resolved to, go and
+explore their country and assist them in their wars, in order to oblige
+them to show me what they had so many times promised to do.
+
+We accordingly caused them all to assemble together, that we might
+communicate to them our intention. When they had heard it, they promised to
+furnish us two thousand five hundred and fifty men of war, who would do
+wonders, with the understanding that I with the same end in view should
+very glad to see them decide so well. Then I proceeded to make known to
+them the methods to be adopted for fighting, in which they took especial
+pleasure, manifesting a strong hope of victory. Everything having been
+decided upon, we separated with the intention of returning for the
+execution of our undertaking. But before entering upon this journey, which
+would require not less than three or four months, it seemed desirable that
+I should go to our settlement to make the necessary arrangements there for
+my absence.
+
+On the ---- day of ---- following I set out on my return to the Riviere des
+Prairies. [92] While there with two canoes of savages I met Father Joseph,
+who was returning from our settlement with some church ornaments for
+celebrating the holy sacrifice of the mass, which was chanted on the border
+of the river with all devotion by the Reverend Fathers Denis and Joseph, in
+presence of all the people, who were amazed at seeing the ceremonies
+observed and the ornaments which seemed to them so handsome. It was
+something which they had never before seen, for these Fathers were the
+first who celebrated here the holy mass.
+
+To return and continue the narrative of my journey: I arrived at Quebec on
+the 26th, where I found the Fathers Jean and Pacifique in good health. They
+on their part did their duty at that place in getting all things ready.
+They celebrated the holy mass, which had never been said there before, nor
+had there ever been any priest in this region.
+
+Having arranged all matters at Quebec, I took with me two men and returned
+to the Riviere des Prairies, in order to go with the savages. I left Quebec
+on the fourth day of July, and on the eighth of the month while _en route_
+I met Sieur du Pont Grave and Father Denis, who were returning to Quebec,
+and who told me that the savages had departed greatly disappointed at my
+not going with them; and that many of them declared that we were dead or
+had been taken by the Iroquois, since I was to be gone only four or five
+days, but had been gone ten. This made them and even our own Frenchmen give
+up hope, so much did they long to see us again. They told me that Father
+Joseph had departed with twelve Frenchmen, who had been furnished to assist
+the savages. This intelligence troubled me somewhat; since, if I had been
+there, I should have arranged many things for the journey, which I could
+not now do. I was troubled not only on account of the small number of men,
+but also because there were only four or five who were acquainted with the
+handling of arms, while in such an expedition the best are not too good in
+this particular. All this however did not cause me to lose courage at all
+for going on with the expedition, on account of the desire I had of
+continuing my explorations. I separated accordingly from Sieurs du Pont
+Grave and Father Denis, determined to go on in the two canoes which I had,
+and follow after the savages, having provided myself with what I needed.
+
+On the 9th of the month I embarked with two others, namely, one of our
+interpreters [93] and my man, accompanied by ten savages in the two canoes,
+these being all they could carry, as they were heavily loaded and
+encumbered with clothes, which prevented me from taking more men.
+
+We continued our voyage up the River St. Lawrence some six leagues, and
+then went by the Riviere des Prairies, which discharges into that river.
+Leaving on the left the Falls of St. Louis, which are five or six leagues
+higher up, and passing several small falls on this river, we entered a
+lake, [94] after passing which we entered the river where I had been
+before, which leads to the Algonquins, [95] a distance of eighty-nine
+leagues [96] from the Falls of St. Louis. Of this river I have made an
+ample description, with an account of my explorations, in my preceding
+book, printed in 1614.[97] For this reason I shall not speak of it in this
+narrative, but pass on directly to the lake of the Algonquins.[98] Here we
+entered a river [99] which flows into this lake, up which we went some
+thirty-five leagues, passing a large number of falls both by land and
+water, the country being far from attractive, and covered with pines,
+birches, and some oaks, being also very rocky, and in many places somewhat
+hilly. Moreover it was very barren and sterile, being but thinly inhabited
+by certain Algonquin savages, called _Otaguottouemin_, [100] who dwell in
+the country, and live by hunting and the fish they catch in the rivers,
+ponds, and lakes, with which the region is well provided. It seems indeed
+that God has been pleased to give to these forbidding and desert lands some
+things in their season for the refreshment of man and the inhabitants of
+these places. For I assure you that there are along the rivers many
+strawberries, also a marvellous quantity of blueberries, [101] a little
+fruit very good to eat, and other small fruits. The people here dry these
+fruits for the winter, as we do plums in France for Lent We left this
+river, which comes from the north, [102] and by which the savages go to the
+Saguenay to barter their furs for tobacco. This place is situated in
+latitude 46 deg., and is very pleasant, but otherwise of little account. [103]
+
+Continuing our journey by land, after leaving the river of the Algonquins,
+we passed several lakes [104] where the savages carry their canoes, and
+entered the lake of the Nipissings,[105] in latitude 46 deg. 15', on the
+twenty-sixth day of the month, having gone by land and the lakes twenty-
+five leagues, or thereabouts.[106] We then arrived at the cabins of the
+savages, with whom we stayed two days. There was a large number of them,
+who gave us a very welcome reception. They are a people who cultivate the
+land but little. A shows the dress of these people as they go to war; B
+that of the women, which differs in no wise from that of the Montagnais and
+the great people of the Algonquins, extending far into the interior.[107]
+
+During the time that I was with them the chief of this tribe and their most
+prominent men entertained us with many banquets according to their custom,
+and took the trouble to go fishing and hunting with me, in order to treat
+me with the greatest courtesy possible. These people are very numerous,
+there being from seven to eight hundred souls, who live in general near the
+lake. This contains a large number of very pleasant islands, among others
+one more than six leagues long, with three or four fine ponds and a number
+of fine meadows; it is bordered by very fine woods, that contain an
+abundance of game, which frequent the little ponds, where the savages also
+catch fish. The northern side of the lake is very pleasant, with fine
+meadows for the grazing of cattle, and many little streams, discharging
+into the lake.
+
+They were fishing at that time in a lake very abundant in various kinds of
+fish, among others one a foot long that was very good. There are also other
+kinds which the savages catch for the purpose of drying and storing away.
+The lake is some eight leagues broad and twenty-five long,[108] into which
+a river [109] flows from the northwest, along which they go to barter the
+merchandise, which we give them in exchange for their peltry, with, those
+who live on it, and who support themselves by hunting and fishing, their
+country containing great quantities of animals, birds, and fish.[110]
+
+After resting two days with the chief of the Nipissings we re-embarked in
+our canoes, and entered a river, by which this lake discharges itself.[111]
+We proceeded down it some thirty-five leagues, and descended several little
+falls by land and by water, until we reached Lake Attigouautan. All this
+region is still more unattractive than the preceding, for I saw along this
+river only ten acres of arable land, the rest being rocky and very hilly.
+It is true that near Lake Attigouautan we found some Indian corn, but only
+in small quantity. Here our savages proceeded to gather some squashes,
+which were acceptable to us, for our provisions began to give out in
+consequence of the bad management of the savages, who ate so heartily at
+the beginning that towards the end very little was left, although we had
+only one meal a day. But, as I have mentioned before, we did not lack for
+blueberries [112] and strawberries; otherwise we should have been in danger
+of being reduced to straits.
+
+We met three hundred men of a tribe we named _Cheveux Releves_, [113] since
+their hair is very high and carefully arranged, and better dressed beyond
+all comparison than that of our courtiers, in spite of their irons and
+refinements. This gives them a handsome appearance. They have no breeches,
+and their bodies are very much pinked in divisions of various shapes. They
+paint their faces in various colors, have their nostrils pierced, and their
+ears adorned with beads. When they go out of their houses they carry a
+club. I visited them, became somewhat acquainted, and formed a friendship
+with them. I gave a hatchet to their chief, who was as much pleased and
+delighted with it as if I had given him some rich present. Entering into
+conversation with him, I inquired in regard to the extent of his country,
+which he pictured to me with coal on the bark of a tree. He gave me to
+understand that he had come into this place for drying the fruit called
+_blues_ [114] to serve for manna in winter, and when they can find nothing
+else. A and C show the manner in which they arm themselves when they go to
+war. They have as arms only the bow and arrow, made in the manner you see
+depicted, and which they regularly carry; also a round shield of dressed
+leather [115] made from an animal like the buffalo. [116]
+
+The next day we separated, and continued our course, along the shore of the
+lake of the Attigouautan, [117] which contains a large number of
+islands. We went some forty-five leagues, all the time along the shore of
+the lake. It is very large, nearly four hundred leagues long from east to
+west, and fifty leagues broad, and in view of its great extent I have named
+it the _Mer Douce_. [118] It is very abundant in various sorts of very good
+fish, both those which we have and those we do not, but especially in
+trout, which are enormously large, some of which I saw as long as four feet
+and a half, the least being two feet and a half. There are also pike of
+like size, and a certain kind of sturgeon, a very large fish and of
+remarkable excellence. The country bordering this lake is partly hilly, as
+on the north side, and partly flat, inhabited by savages, and thinly
+covered with wood, including oaks. After crossing a bay, which forms one of
+the extremities of the lake, [119] we went some seven leagues until we
+arrived in the country of the Attigouautan at a village called _Otoueacha_,
+on the first day of August. Here we found a great change in the country. It
+was here very fine, the largest part being cleared up, and many hills and
+several rivers rendering the region agreeable. I went to see their Indian
+corn, which was at that time far advanced for the season.
+
+These localities seemed to me very pleasant, in comparison with so
+disagreeable a region as that from which we had come. The next day I went
+to another village, called _Carmaron_, a league distant from this, where
+they received us in a very friendly manner, making for us a banquet with
+their bread, squashes, and fish. As to meat, that is very scarce there. The
+chief of this village earnestly begged me to stay, to which I could not
+consent, but returned to our village, where on the next night but one, as I
+went out of the cabin to escape the fleas, of which there were large
+numbers and by which we were tormented, a girl of little modesty came
+boldly to me and offered to keep me company, for which I thanked her,
+sending her away with gentle remonstrances, and spent the night with some
+savages.
+
+The next day I departed from this village to go to another, called
+_Touaguainchain_, and to another, called _Tequenonquiaye_, in which we were
+received in a very friendly manner by the inhabitants, who showed us the
+best cheer they could with their Indian corn served in various styles. This
+country is very fine and fertile, and travelling through it is very
+pleasant.
+
+Thence I had them guide me to Carhagouha, which was fortified by a triple
+palisade of wood thirty-five feet high for its defence and protection. In
+this village Father Joseph was staying, whom we saw and were very glad to
+find well. He on his part was no less glad, and was expecting nothing so
+little as to see me in this country. On the twelfth day of August the
+Recollect Father celebrated the holy mass, and a cross was planted near a
+small house apart from the village, which the savages built while I was
+staying there, awaiting the arrival of our men and their preparation to go
+to the war, in which they had been for a long time engaged.
+
+Finding that they were so slow in assembling their army, and that I should
+have time to visit their country, I resolved to go by short days' journeys
+from village to village as far as Cahiague, where the rendezvous of the
+entire army was to be, and which was fourteen leagues distant from
+Carhagouha, from which village I set out on the fourteenth of August with
+ten of my companions. I visited five of the more important villages, which
+were enclosed with palisades of wood, and reached Cahiague, the principal
+village of the country, where there were two hundred large cabins and where
+all the men of war were to assemble. Now in all these villages they
+received us very courteously with their simple welcome. All the country
+where I went contains some twenty to thirty leagues, is very fine, and
+situated in latitude 44 deg. 30'. It is very extensively cleared up. They plant
+in it a great quantity of Indian corn, which grows there finely. They plant
+likewise squashes,[120] and sun-flowers,[121] from the seed of which they
+make oil, with which they anoint the head. The region is extensively
+traversed with brooks, discharging into the lake. There are many very good
+vines [122] and plums, which are excellent,[123] raspberries,[124]
+strawberries,[125] little wild apples,[126] nuts,[127] and a kind of fruit
+of the form and color of small lemons, with a similar taste, but having an
+interior which is very good and almost like that of figs. The plant which
+bears this fruit is two and a half feet high, with but three or four leaves
+at most, which are of the shape of those of the fig-tree, and each plant
+bears but two pieces of fruit. There are many of these plants in various
+places, the fruit being very good and savory.[128] Oaks, elms, and beeches
+[129] are numerous here, as also forests of fir, the regular retreat of
+partridges [130] and hares.[131] There are also quantities of small
+cherries [132] and black cherries,[133] and the same varieties of wood that
+we have in our forests in France. The soil seems to me indeed a little
+sandy, yet it is for all that good for their kind of cereal. The small
+tract of country which I visited is thickly settled with a countless number
+of human beings, not to speak of the other districts where I did not go,
+and which, according to general report, are as thickly settled or more so
+than those mentioned above. I reflected what a great misfortune it is that
+so many poor creatures live and die without the knowledge of God, and even
+without any religion or law established among them, whether divine,
+political, or civil; for they neither worship, nor pray to any object, at
+least so far as I could perceive from their conversation. But they have,
+however, some sort of ceremony, which I shall describe in its proper place,
+in regard to the sick, or in order to ascertain what is to happen to them,
+and even in regard to the dead. These, however, are the works of certain
+persons among them, who want to be confidentially consulted in such
+matters, as was the case among the ancient pagans, who allowed themselves
+to be carried away by the persuasions of magicians and diviners. Yet the
+greater part of the people do not believe at all in what these charlatans
+do and say. They are very generous to one another in regard to provisions,
+but otherwise very avaricious. They do not give in return. They are clothed
+with deer and beaver skins, which they obtain from the Algonquins and
+Nipissings in exchange for Indian corn and meal.
+
+On the 17th of August I arrived at Cahiague, where I was received with
+great joy and gladness by all the savages of the country, who had abandoned
+their undertaking, in the belief that they would see me no more, and that
+the Iroquois had captured me, as I have before stated. This was the cause
+of the great delay experienced in this expedition, they even having
+postponed it to the following year. Meanwhile they received intelligence
+that a certain nation of their allies, [134] dwelling three good days'
+journeys beyond the Entouhonorons, [135] on whom the Iroquois also make
+war, desired to assist them in this expedition with five hundred good men;
+also to form an alliance and establish a friendship with us, that we might
+all engage in the war together; moreover that they greatly desired to see
+us and give expression to the pleasure they would have in making our
+acquaintance.
+
+I was glad to find this opportunity for gratifying my desire of obtaining a
+knowledge of their country. It is situated only seven days from where the
+Dutch [136] go to traffic on the fortieth degree. The savages there,
+assisted by the Dutch, make war upon them, take them prisoners, and cruelly
+put them to death; and indeed they told us that the preceding year, while
+making war, they captured three of the Dutch, who were assisting their
+enemies, [137] as we do the Attigouautans, and while in action one of their
+own men was killed. Nevertheless they did not fail to send back the three
+Dutch prisoners, without doing them any harm, supposing that they belonged
+to our party, since they had no knowledge of us except by hearsay, never
+having seen a Christian; otherwise, they said, these three prisoners would
+not have got off so easily, and would not escape again should they surprise
+and take them. This nation is very warlike, as those of the nation of the
+Attigouautans maintain. They have only three villages, which are in the
+midst of more than twenty others, on which they make war without assistance
+from their friends; for they are obliged to pass through the thickly
+settled country of the Chouontouaroueon,[138] or else they would have to
+make a very long circuit.
+
+After arriving at the village, it was necessary for me to remain until the
+men of war should come from the surrounding villages, so that we might be
+off as soon as possible. During this time there was a constant succession
+of banquets and dances on account of the joy they experienced at seeing me
+so determined to assist them in their war, just as if they were already
+assured of victory.
+
+The greater portion of our men having assembled, we set out from the
+village on the first day of September, and passed along the shore of a
+small lake, [139] distant three leagues from the village, where they catch
+large quantities of fish, which they preserve for the winter. There is
+another lake, [140] closely adjoining, which is twenty-five leagues in
+circuit, and slows into the small one by a strait, where the above
+mentioned extensive fishing is carried on. This is done by means of a large
+number of stakes which almost close the strait, only some little openings
+being left where they place their nets, in which the fish are caught. These
+two lakes discharge into the _Mer Douce_. We remained some time in this
+place to await the rest of our savages. When they were all assembled, with
+their arms, meal, and necessaries, it was decided to choose some of the
+most resolute men to compose a party to go and give notice of our departure
+to those who were to assist us with five hundred men, that they might join
+us, and that we might appear together before the fort of the enemy. This
+decision having been made, they dispatched two canoes, with twelve of the
+most stalwart savages, and also with one of our interpreters, [141] who
+asked me to permit him to make the journey, which I readily accorded,
+inasmuch as he was led to do so of his own will, and as he might in this
+way see their country and get a knowledge of the people living there. The
+danger, however, was not small, since it was necessary to pass through the
+midst of enemies. They set out on the 8th of the month, and on the 10th
+following there was a heavy white frost.
+
+We continued our journey towards the enemy, and went some five or six
+leagues through these lakes, [142] when the savages carried their canoes
+about ten leagues by land. We then came to another lake, [143] six to seven
+leagues in length and three broad. From this flows a river which discharges
+into the great lake of the Entouhonorons. After traversing this lake we
+passed a fall, and continuing our course down this river for about
+sixty-four leagues [144] entered the lake of the Entouhonorons, having
+passed, on our way by land, five falls, some being from four to five
+leagues long. We also passed several lakes of considerable size, through
+which the river passes. The latter is large and very abundant in good fish.
+
+It is certain that all this region is very fine and pleasant. Along the
+banks it seems as if the trees had been set out for ornament in most
+places, and that all these tracts were in former times inhabited by
+savages, who were subsequently compelled to abandon them from fear of their
+enemies. Vines and nut-trees are here very numerous. Grapes mature, yet
+there is always a very pungent tartness which is felt remaining in the
+throat when one eats them in large quantities, arising from defect of
+cultivation. These localities are very pleasant when cleared up.
+
+Stags and bears are here very abundant. We tried the hunt and captured a
+large number as we journeyed down. It was done in this way. They place four
+or five hundred savages in line in the woods, so that they extend to
+certain points on the river; then marching in order with bow and arrow in
+hand, shouting and making a great noise in order to frighten the beasts,
+they continue to advance until they come to the end of the point. Then all
+the animals between the point and the hunters are forced to throw
+themselves into the water, as many at least as do not fall by the arrows
+shot at them by the hunters. Meanwhile the savages, who are expressly
+arranged and posted in their canoes along the shore, easily approach the
+stags and other animals, tired out and greatly frightened in the chase,
+when they readily kill them with the spear heads attached to the extremity
+of a piece of wood of the shape of a half pike. This is the way they engage
+in the chase; and they do likewise on the islands where there are large
+quantities of game. I took especial pleasure in seeing them hunt thus and
+in observing their dexterity. Many animals were killed by the shot of the
+arquebus, at which the savages were greatly surprised. But it unfortunately
+happened that, while a stag was being killed, a savage, who chanced to come
+in range, was wounded by a shot of an arquebus. Thence a great commotion
+arose among them, which however subsided when some presents were given to
+the wounded. This is the usual manner of allaying and settling quarrels,
+and, in case of the death of the wounded, presents are given to the
+relatives of the one killed.
+
+As to smaller game there is a large quantity of it in its season. There are
+also many cranes,[145] white as swans, and other varieties of birds like
+those in France.
+
+We proceeded by short days' journeys as far as the shore of the lake of the
+Entouhonorons, constantly hunting as before mentioned. Here at its eastern
+extremity, which is the entrance to the great River St. Lawrence, we made
+the traverse, in latitude 43 deg., [146] where in the passage there are very
+large beautiful islands. We went about fourteen leagues in passing to the
+southern side of the lake towards the territory of the enemy. [147] The
+savages concealed all their canoes in the woods near the shore. We went
+some four leagues over a sandy strand, where I observed a very pleasant and
+beautiful country, intersected by many little streams and two small rivers,
+which discharge into the before-mentioned lake, also many ponds and
+meadows, where there was an endless amount of game, many vines, fine woods,
+and a large number of chestnut trees, whose fruit was still in the burr.
+The chestnuts are small, but of a good flavor. The country is covered with
+forests, which over its greater portion have not been cleared up. All the
+canoes being thus hidden, we left the border of the lake, [148] which is
+some eighty leagues long and twenty-five wide. [149] The greater portion of
+its shores is inhabited by savages. We continued our course by land for
+about twenty-five or thirty leagues. In the space of four days we crossed
+many brooks, and a river which proceeds from a lake that discharges into
+that of the Entouhonorons. [150] This lake is twenty-five or thirty leagues
+in circuit, contains some fine islands, and is the place where our enemies,
+the Iroquois, catch their fish, in which it abounds.
+
+On the 9th of the month of October our savages going out to reconnoitre met
+eleven savages, whom they took prisoners. They consisted of four women,
+three boys, one girl, and three men, who were going fishing and were
+distant some four leagues from the fort of the enemy. Now it is to be noted
+that one of the chiefs, on seeing the prisoners, cut off the finger of one
+of these poor women as a beginning of their usual punishment; upon which I
+interposed and reprimanded the chief, Iroquet, representing to him that it
+was not the act of a warrior, as he declared himself to be, to conduct
+himself with cruelty towards women, who have no defence but their tears and
+that one should treat them with humanity on account of their helplessness
+and weakness; and I told him that on the contrary this act would be deemed
+to proceed from a base and brutal courage, and that if he committed any
+more of these cruelties he would not give me heart to assist them or favor
+them in the war. To which the only answer he gave me was that their enemies
+treated them in the same manner, but that, since this was displeasing to
+me, he would not do anything more to the women, although; he would to the
+men.
+
+The next day, at three o'clock in the afternoon, we arrived before the fort
+[151] of their enemies, where the savages made some skirmishes with each
+other, although our design was not to disclose ourselves until the next
+day, which however the impatience of our savages would not permit, both on
+account of their desire to see fire opened upon their enemies, and also
+that they might rescue some of their own men who had become too closely
+engaged, and were hotly pressed. Then I approached the enemy, and although
+I had only a few men, yet we showed them what they had never seen nor heard
+before; for, as soon as they saw us and heard the arquebus shots and the
+balls whizzing in their ears, they withdrew speedily to their fort,
+carrying the dead and wounded in this charge. We also withdrew to our main
+body, with five or six wounded, one of whom died.
+
+This done, we withdrew to the distance of cannon range, out of sight of the
+enemy, but contrary to my advice and to what they had promised me. This
+moved me to address them very rough and angry words in order to incite them
+to do their duty, foreseeing that if everything should go according to
+their whim and the guidance of their council, their utter ruin would be the
+result. Nevertheless I did not fail to send to them and propose means which
+they should use in order to get possession of their enemies.
+
+These were, to make with certain kinds of wood a _cavalier_, which should
+be higher than the palisades. Upon this were to be placed four or five of
+our arquebusiers, who should keep up a constant fire over their palisades
+and galleries, which were well provided with stones, and by this means
+dislodge the enemy who might attack us from their galleries. Meanwhile
+orders were to be given to procure boards for making a sort of mantelet to
+protect our men from the arrows and stones of which the savages generally
+make use. These instruments, namely the cavalier and mantelets, were
+capable of being carried by a large number of men. One mantelet was so
+constructed that the water could not extinguish the fire, which might be
+set to the fort, under cover of the arquebusiers who were doing their duty
+on the cavalier. In this manner, I told them, we might be able to defend
+ourselves so that the enemy could not approach to extinguish the fire which
+we should set to their ramparts.
+
+This proposition they thought good and very seasonable, and immediately
+proceeded to carry it out as I directed. In fact the next day they set to
+work, some to cut wood, others to gather it, for building and equipping the
+cavalier and mantelets. The work was promptly executed and in less than
+four hours, although the amount of wood they had collected for burning
+against the ramparts, in order to set fire to them, was very small. Their
+expectation was that the five hundred men who had promised to come would do
+so on this day, but doubt was felt about them, since they had not appeared
+at the rendezvous, as they had been charged to do, and as they had
+promised. This greatly troubled our savages; but seeing that they were
+sufficiently numerous to take the fort without other assistance, and
+thinking for my part that delay, if not in all things at least in many, is
+prejudicial, I urged them to attack it, representing to them that the
+enemy, having become aware of their force and our arms, which pierced
+whatever was proof against arrows, had begun to barricade themselves and
+cover themselves with strong pieces of wood, with which they were well
+provided and their village filled. I told them that the least delay was the
+best, since the enemy had already strengthened themselves very much; for
+their village was enclosed by four good palisades, which were made of great
+pieces of wood, interlaced with each other, with an opening of not more
+than half a foot between two, and which were thirty feet high, with
+galleries after the manner of a parapet, which they had furnished with
+double pieces of wood that were proof against our arquebus shots. Moreover
+it was near a pond where the water was abundant, and was well supplied with
+gutters, placed between each pair of palisades, to throw out water, which
+they had also under cover inside, in order to extinguish fire. Now this is
+the character of their fortifications and defences, which are much stronger
+than the villages of the Attigouautan and others.
+
+We approached to attack the village, our cavalier being carried by two
+hundred of the strongest men, who put it down before the village at a
+pike's length off. I ordered three arquebusiers to mount upon it, who were
+well protected from the arrows and stones that could be shot or hurled at
+them. Meanwhile the enemy did not fail to send a large number of arrows
+which did not miss, and a great many stones, which they hurled from their
+palisades. Nevertheless a hot fire of arquebuses forced them to dislodge
+and abandon their galleries, in consequence of the cavalier which uncovered
+them, they not venturing to show themselves, but fighting under shelter.
+Now when the cavalier was carried forward, instead of bringing up the
+mantelets according to order, including that one under cover of which we
+were to set the fire, they abandoned them and began to scream at their
+enemies, shooting arrows into the fort, which in my opinion did little harm
+to the enemy.
+
+But we must excuse them, for they are not warriors, and besides will have
+no discipline nor correction, and will do only what they please.
+Accordingly one of them set fire inconsiderately to the wood placed against
+the fort of the enemy, quite the wrong way and in the face of the wind, so
+that it produced no effect.
+
+This fire being out, the greater part of the savages began to carry wood
+against the palisades, but in so small quantity that the fire could have no
+great effect. There also arose such disorder among them that one could not
+understand another, which greatly troubled me. In vain did I shout in their
+ears and remonstrate to my utmost with them as to the danger to which they
+exposed themselves by their bad behavior, but on account of the great noise
+they made they heard nothing. Seeing that shouting would only burst my
+head, and that my remonstrances were useless for putting a stop to the
+disorder, I did nothing more, but determined together with my men to do
+what we could, and fire upon such as we could see.
+
+Meanwhile the enemy profited by our disorder to get water and pour it so
+abundantly that you would have said brooks were flowing through their
+spouts, the result of which was that the fire was instantly extinguished,
+while they did not cease shooting their arrows, which fell upon us like
+hail. But the men on the cavalier killed and maimed many. We were engaged
+in this combat about three hours, in which two of our chiefs and leading
+warriors were wounded, namely, one called _Ochateguain_ and another
+_Orani_, together with some fifteen common warriors. The others, seeing
+their men and some of the chiefs wounded, now began to talk of a retreat
+without farther fighting, in expectation of the five hundred men, [152]
+whose arrival could not be much delayed. Thus they retreated, a disorderly
+rabble.
+
+Moreover the chiefs have in fact no absolute control over their men, who
+are governed by their own will and follow their own fancy, which is the
+cause of their disorder and the ruin of all their undertakings; for, having
+determined upon anything with their leaders, it needs only the whim of a
+villain, or nothing at all, to lead them to break it off and form a new
+plan. Thus there is no concert of action among them, as can be seen by this
+expedition.
+
+Now we withdrew into our fort, I having received two arrow wounds, one in
+the leg, the other in the knee, which caused me great inconvenience, aside
+from the severe pain. When they were all assembled, I addressed them some
+words of remonstrance on the disorder that had occurred. But all I said
+availed nothing, and had no effect upon them. They replied that many of
+their men had been wounded like myself, so that it would cause the others
+much trouble and inconvenience to carry them as they retreated, and that it
+was not possible to return again against their enemies, as I told them it
+was their duty to do. They agreed, however, to wait four days longer for
+the five hundred men who were to come; and, if they came, to make a second
+effort against their enemies, and execute better what I might tell them
+than they had done in the past. With this I had to content myself, to my
+great regret.
+
+Herewith is indicated the manner in which they fortify their towns, from
+which representation it may be inferred that those of their friends and
+enemies are fortified in like manner.
+
+The next day there was a violent wind, which lasted two days, and was very
+favorable for setting fire anew to the fort of the enemy which, although I
+urged them strongly, they were unwilling to do, as if they were afraid of
+getting the worst of it, and besides they pleaded their wounded as an
+excuse.
+
+We remained in camp until the 16th of the month, [153] during which time
+there were some skirmishes between the enemy and our men, who were very
+often surrounded by the former, rather through their imprudence than from
+lack of courage; for I assure you that every time we went to the charge it
+was necessary for us to go and disengage them from the crowd, since they
+could only retreat under cover of our arquebusiers, whom the enemy greatly
+dreaded and feared; for as soon as they perceived any one of the
+arquebusiers they withdrew speedily, saying in a persuasive manner that we
+should not interfere in their combats, and that their enemies had very
+little courage to require us to assist them, with many other words of like
+tenor, in order to prevail upon us.
+
+I have represented by figure E the manner in which they arm themselves in
+going to war.
+
+After some days, seeing that the five hundred men did not come, they
+determined to depart, and enter upon their retreat as soon as possible.
+They proceeded to make a kind of basket for carrying the wounded, who are
+put into it crowded up in a heap, being bound and pinioned in such a manner
+that it is as impossible for them to move as for an infant in its swaddling
+clothes; but this is, not without causing the wounded much extreme
+pain. This I can say with truth from my own experience, having been carried
+some days, since I could not stand up, particularly on account of an
+arrow-wound which I had received in the knee. I never found myself in such
+a _gehenna_ as during this time, for the pain which I suffered in
+consequence of the wound in my knee was nothing in comparison with that
+which I endured while I was carried bound and pinioned on the back of one
+of our savages; so that I lost my patience, and as soon as I could sustain
+myself, got out of this prison, or rather _gehenna_.
+
+The enemy followed us about half a league, though at a distance, with the
+view of trying to take some of those composing the rear guard; but their
+efforts were vain, and they retired.
+
+Now the only good point that I have seen in their mode of warfare is that
+they make their retreat very securely, placing all the wounded and aged in
+their centre, being well armed on the wings and in the rear, and continuing
+this order without interruption until they reach a place of security.
+
+Their retreat was very long, being from twenty-five to thirty leagues,
+which caused the wounded much fatigue, as also those who carried them,
+although the latter relieved each other from time to time.
+
+On the 18th day of the month there fell much snow and hail, accompanied by
+a strong wind, which greatly incommoded us. Nevertheless we succeeded in
+arriving at the shore of the lake of the Entouhonorons, at the place where
+our canoes were concealed, which we found all intact, for we had been
+afraid lest the enemy might have broken them up.
+
+When they were all assembled, and I saw that they were ready to depart to
+their village, I begged them to take me to our settlement, which, though
+unwilling at first, they finally concluded to do, and sought four men to
+conduct me. Four men were found, who offered themselves of their own
+accord; for, as I have before said, the chiefs have no control over their
+men, in consequence of which they are often unable to do as they would
+like. Now the men having been found, it was necessary also to find a canoe,
+which was not to be had, each one needing his own, and there being no more
+than they required. This was far from being pleasant to me, but, on the
+contrary greatly annoyed me, since it led me to suspect some evil purpose,
+inasmuch as they had promised to conduct me to our settlement after their
+war. Moreover I was poorly prepared for spending the winter with them, or
+else should not have been concerned about the matter. But not being able to
+do anything, I was obliged to resign myself in patience. Now after some
+days I perceived that their plan was to keep me and my companions, not only
+as a security for themselves, for they feared their enemies, but also that
+I might listen to what took place in their councils and assemblies, and
+determine what they should do in the future against their enemies for their
+security and preservation.
+
+The next day, the 28th of the month, they began to make preparations; some
+to go deer-hunting, others to hunt bears and beavers, others to go fishing,
+others to return to their villages. An abode and lodging were furnished me
+by one of the principal chiefs, called _D'Arontal_, with whom I already had
+some acquaintance. Having offered me his cabin, provisions, and
+accommodations, he set out also for the deer-hunt, which is esteemed by
+them the greatest and most noble one. After crossing, from the island,
+[154] the end of the lake, we entered a river [155] some twelve leagues in
+extent. They then carried their canoes by land some half a league, when we
+entered a lake [156] which was some ten or twelve leagues in circuit, where
+there was a large amount of game, as swans, [157] white cranes, [158]
+outardes, [159] ducks, teal, song-thrush, [160] larks, [161] snipe, [162]
+geese, [163] and several other kinds of fowl too numerous to mention. Of
+these I killed a great number, which stood us in good stead while waiting
+for the capture of a deer. From there we proceeded to a certain place some
+ten leagues distant, where our savages thought there were deer in
+abundance. Assembled there were some twenty-five savages, who set to
+building two or three cabins out of pieces of wood fitted to each other,
+the chinks of which they stopped up by means of moss to prevent the
+entrance of the air, covering them with the bark of trees.
+
+When they had done this they went into the woods to a small forest of firs,
+where they made an enclosure in the form of a triangle, closed up on two
+sides and open on one. This enclosure was made of great stakes of wood
+closely pressed together, from eight to nine feet high, each of the sides
+being fifteen hundred paces long. At the extremity of this triangle there
+was a little enclosure, constantly diminishing in size, covered in part
+with boughs and with only an opening of five feet, about the width of a
+medium-sized door, into which the deer were to enter. They were so
+expeditious in their work, that in less than ten days they had their
+enclosure in readiness. Meanwhile other savages had gone fishing, catching
+trout and pike of prodigious size, and enough to meet all our wants.
+
+All preparations being made, they set out half an hour before day to go
+into the wood, some half a league from the before-mentioned enclosure,
+separated from each other some eighty paces. Each had two sticks, which
+they struck together, and they marched in this order at a slow pace until
+they arrived at their enclosure. The deer hearing this noise flee before
+them until they reach the enclosure, into which the savages force them to
+go. Then they gradually unite on approaching the bay and opening of their
+triangle, the deer skirting the sides until they reach the end, to which
+the savages hotly pursue them, with bow and arrow in hand ready to let fly.
+On reaching the end of the triangle they begin to shout and imitate wolves,
+[164] which are numerous, and which devour the deer. The deer, hearing this
+frightful noise, are constrained to enter the retreat by the little
+opening, whither they are very hotly pursued by arrow shots. Having entered
+this retreat, which is so well closed and fastened that they can by no
+possibility get out, they are easily captured. I assure you that there is a
+singular pleasure in this chase, which took place every two days, and was
+so successful that, in the thirty-eight days [165] during which we were
+there, they captured one hundred and twenty deer, which they make good use
+of, reserving the fat for winter, which they use as we do butter, and
+taking away to their homes some of the flesh for their festivities.
+
+They have other contrivances for capturing the deer; as snares, with which
+they kill many. You see depicted opposite the manner of their chase,
+enclosure, and snare. Out of the skins they make garments. Thus you see how
+we spent the time while waiting for the frost, that we might return the
+more easily, since the country is very marshy.
+
+When they first went out hunting, I lost my way in the woods, having
+followed a certain bird that seemed to me peculiar. It had a beak like that
+of a parrot, and was of the size of a hen. It was entirely yellow, except
+the head which was red, and the wings which were blue, and it flew by
+intervals like a partridge. The desire to kill it led me to pursue it from
+tree to tree for a very long time, until it flew away in good earnest. Thus
+losing all hope, I desired to retrace my steps, but found none of our
+hunters, who had been constantly getting ahead, and had reached the
+enclosure. While trying to overtake them, and going, as it seemed to me,
+straight to where the enclosure was, I found myself lost in the woods,
+going now on this side now on that, without being able to recognize my
+position. The night coming on, I was obliged to spend it at the foot of a
+great tree, and in the morning set out and walked until three o'clock in
+the afternoon, when I came to a little pond of still water. Here I noticed
+some game, which I pursued, killing three or four birds, which were very
+acceptable, since I had had nothing to eat. Unfortunately for me there had
+been no sunshine for three days, nothing but rain and cloudy weather, which
+increased my trouble. Tired and exhausted I prepared to rest myself and
+cook the birds in order to alleviate the hunger which I began painfully to
+feel, and which by God's favor was appeased.
+
+When I had made my repast I began to consider what I should do, and to pray
+God to give me the will and courage to sustain patiently my misfortune if I
+should be obliged to remain abandoned in this forest without counsel or
+consolation except the Divine goodness and mercy, and at the same time to
+exert myself to return to our hunters. Thus committing all to His mercy I
+gathered up renewed courage going here and there all day, without
+perceiving any foot-print or path, except those of wild beasts, of which I
+generally saw a good number. I was obliged to pass here this night
+also. Unfortunately I had forgotten to bring with me a small compass which
+would have put me on the right road, or nearly so. At the dawn of day,
+after a brief repast, I set out in order to find, if possible, some brook
+and follow it, thinking that it must of necessity flow into the river on
+the border of which our hunters were encamped. Having resolved upon this
+plan, I carried it out so well that at noon I found myself on the border of
+a little lake, about a league and a half in extent, where I killed some
+game, which was very timely for my wants; I had likewise remaining some
+eight or ten charges of powder, which was a great satisfaction.
+
+I proceeded along the border of this lake to see where it discharged, and
+found a large brook, which I followed until five o'clock in the evening,
+when I heard a great noise, but on carefully listening failed to perceive
+clearly what it was. On hearing the noise, however, more distinctly, I
+concluded that it was a fall of water in the river which I was searching
+for. I proceeded nearer, and saw an opening, approaching which I found
+myself in a great and far-reaching meadow, where there was a large number
+of wild beasts, and looking to my right I perceived the river, broad and
+long. I looked to see if I could not recognize the place, and walking along
+on the meadow I noticed a little path where the savages carried their
+canoes. Finally, after careful observation, I recognized it as the same
+river, and that I had gone that way before.
+
+I passed the night in better spirits than the previous ones, supping on the
+little I had. In the morning I re-examined the place where I was, and
+concluded from certain mountains on the border of the river that I had not
+been deceived, and that our hunters must be lower down by four or five good
+leagues. This distance I walked at my leisure along the border of the
+river, until I perceived the smoke of our hunters, where I arrived to the
+great pleasure not only of myself but of them, who were still searching for
+me, but had about given up all hopes of seeing me again. They begged me not
+to stray off from them any more, or never to forget to carry with me my
+compass, and they added: If you had not come, and we had not succeeded in
+finding you, we should never have gone again to the French, for fear of
+their accusing us of having killed you. After this he [166] was very
+careful of me when I went hunting, always giving me a savage as companion,
+who knew how to find again the place from which he started so well that it
+was something very remarkable.
+
+To return to my subject: they have a kind of superstition in regard to this
+hunt; namely, they believe that if they should roast any of the meat taken
+in this way, or if any of the fat should fall into the fire, or if any of
+the bones should be thrown into it, they would not be able to capture any
+more deer. Accordingly they begged me to roast none of this meat, but I
+laughed at this and their way of doing. Yet, in order not to offend them,
+I cheerfully desisted, at least in their presence; though when they were
+out of sight I took some of the best and roasted it, attaching no credit to
+their superstitions. When I afterwards told them what I had done, they
+would not believe me, saying that they could not have taken any deer after
+the doing of such a thing.
+
+On the fourth day of December we set out from this place, walking on the
+river, lakes, and ponds, which were frozen, and sometimes through the
+woods. Thus we went for nineteen days, undergoing much hardship and toil,
+both the savages, who were loaded with a hundred pounds, and myself, who
+carried a burden of twenty pounds, which in the long journey tired me very
+much. It is true that I was sometimes relieved by our savages, but
+nevertheless I suffered great discomfort. The savages, in order to go over
+the ice more easily, are accustomed to make a kind of wooden sledge, [167]
+on which they put their loads, which they easily and swiftly drag along.
+Some days after there was a thaw, which caused us much trouble and
+annoyance; for we had to go through pine forests full of brooks, ponds;
+marshes, and swamps, where many trees had been blown down upon each
+other. This caused us a thousand troubles and embarrassments, and great
+discomfort, as we were all the time wet to above our knees. We were four
+days in this plight, since in most places the ice would not bear. At last,
+on the 20th of the month, we succeeded in arriving at our village. [168]
+Here the Captain Yroquet had come to winter with his companions, who are
+Algonquins, also his son, whom he brought for the sake of treatment, since
+while hunting he had been seriously injured by a bear which he was trying
+to kill.
+
+After resting some days I determined to go and visit Father Joseph, and to
+see in winter the people where he was, whom the war had not permitted me to
+see in the summer. I set out from this village on the 14th [169] of January
+following, thanking my host for the kindness he had shown me, and, taking
+formal leave of him, as I did not expect to see him again for three months.
+
+The next day I Saw Father Joseph, [170] in his small house where he had
+taken up his abode, as I have before stated. I stayed with him some days,
+finding him deliberating about making a journey to the Petun people, as I
+had also thought of doing, although it was very disagreeable travelling in
+winter. We set out together on the fifteenth of February to go to that
+nation, where we arrived on the seventeenth of the month. [171] These Petun
+people plant the maize, called by us _ble de Turquie_, and have fixed
+abodes like the rest. We went to seven other villages of their neighbors
+and allies, with whom we contracted friendship, and who promised to come in
+good numbers to our settlement. They welcomed us with good cheer, making a
+banquet with meat and fish, as is their custom. To this the people from all
+quarters flocked in order to see us, showing many manifestations of
+friendship, and accompanying us on the greater part of our way back. The
+country is diversified with pleasant slopes and plains. They were beginning
+to build two villages, through which we passed, and which were situated in
+the midst of the woods, because of the convenience [172] of building and
+fortifying their towns there. These people live like the Attignouaatitans,
+[173] and have the same customs. They are situated near the Nation Neutre,
+[174] which are powerful and occupy a great extent of country. After
+visiting these people, we set out from that place, and went to a nation of
+savages, whom we named _Cheveux Releves_ [175] They were very happy to see
+us again, and we entered into friendship with them, while they in return
+promised to come and see us, namely at the habitation in this place.
+
+It has seemed to me desirable to describe them and their country, their
+customs and mode of life. In the first place they are at war with another
+nation of savages, called Asistagueroueon, [176] which means _Gens de Feu_,
+who are distant from them ten days' journey. I informed myself accordingly
+very particularly in regard to their country and the tribes living there,
+as also to their character and numbers. The people of this nation are very
+numerous, and are for the most part great warriors, hunters, and
+fishermen. They have several chiefs, each ruling in his own district. In
+general they plant Indian corn, and other cereals. They are hunters who go
+in troops to various regions and countries, where they traffic with other
+nations, distant four or five hundred leagues. They are the cleanest
+savages in their household affairs that I have ever seen, and are very
+industrious in making a kind of mat, which constitutes their Turkish
+carpets. The women have the body covered, but the men go uncovered, with
+the exception of a fur robe in the form of a cloak, which they usually
+leave off in summer. The women and girls are not more moved at seeing them
+thus, than if they saw nothing unusual. The women live very happily with
+their husbands. They have the following custom when they have their
+catamenia: the wives withdraw from their husbands, or the daughter from her
+father and mother and other relatives, and go to certain small houses.
+There they remain in retirement, awaiting their time, without any company
+of men, who bring them food and necessaries until their return. Thus it is
+known who have their catamenia and who have not. This tribe is accustomed
+more than others to celebrate great banquets. They gave us good cheer and
+welcomed us very cordially, earnestly begging me to assist them against
+their enemies, who dwell on the banks of the _Mer Douce_, two hundred
+leagues distant; to which I replied that they must wait until another time,
+as I was not provided with the necessary means. They were at a loss how to
+welcome us. I have represented them in figure C as they go to war.
+
+There is, also, at a distance of a two days' journey from them, in a
+southerly direction, another savage nation, that produces a large amount of
+tobacco. This is called _Nation Neutre_. They number four thousand
+warriors, and dwell westward of the lake of the Entouhonorons, which is
+from eighty to a hundred leagues in extent. They, however, assist the
+_Cheveux Releves_ against the _Gens de Feu_. But with the Iroquois and our
+allies they are at peace, and preserve a neutrality. There is a cordial
+understanding towards both of these nations, and they do not venture to
+engage in any dispute or quarrel, but on the contrary often eat and drink
+with them like good friends. I was very desirous of visiting this nation,
+but the people where we were dissuaded me from it, saying that the year
+before one of our men had killed one of them, when we were at war with the
+Entouhonorons, which offended them; and they informed us that they are much
+inclined to revenge, not concerning themselves as to who struck the blow,
+but inflicting the penalty upon the first one they meet of the nation, even
+though one of their friends, when they succeed in catching him, unless
+harmony has been previously restored between them, and gifts and presents
+bestowed upon the relatives of the deceased. Thus I was prevented for the
+time being from going, although some of this nation assured us that they
+would do us no harm for the reason assigned above.
+
+Thus we were led to return the same way we had come, and continuing my
+journey, I reached the nation of the _Pisierinii_, [177] who had promised
+to conduct me farther on in the prosecution of my plans and explorations.
+But I was prevented by the intelligence which came from our great village
+and the Algonquins, where Captain Yroquet was, namely, that the people of
+the nation of the Atignouaatitans [178] had placed in his hands a prisoner
+of a hostile nation, in the expectation that this Captain Yroquet would
+exercise on the prisoner the revenge usual among them. But they said that,
+instead of doing so, he had not only set him at liberty, but, having found
+him apt, and an excellent hunter, had treated him as his son, on account of
+which the Atignouaatitans had become jealous and resolved upon vengeance,
+and had in fact appointed a man to go and kill this prisoner, allied as he
+was. As he was put to death in the presence of the chiefs of the Algonquin
+nation, they, indignant at such an act and moved to anger, killed on the
+spot this rash murderer; whereupon the Atignouaatitans feeling themselves
+insulted, seeing one of their comrades dead, seized their arms and went to
+the tents of the Algonquins, who were passing the winter near the above
+mentioned village, and belabored them severely, Captain Yroquet receiving
+two arrow wounds. At another time they pillaged some of the cabins of the
+Algonquins before the latter could place themselves in a state of defence,
+so that they had not an equal chance. Notwithstanding this they were not
+reconciled to the Algonquins, who for securing peace had given the
+Atignouaatitans fifty necklaces of porcelain and a hundred branches of the
+same [179] which they value highly, and likewise a number of kettles and
+axes, together with two female prisoners in place of the dead man. They
+were, in a word, still in a state of violent animosity. The Algonquins were
+obliged to suffer patiently this great rage, and feared that they might all
+be killed, not feeling any security, notwithstanding their gifts, until
+they should be differently situated. This intelligence greatly disturbed
+me, when I considered the harm that might arise not only to them, but to us
+as well, who were in their country.
+
+I then met two or three savages of our large village, who earnestly
+entreated me to go to them in order to effect a reconciliation, declaring
+that if I did not go none of them would come to us any more, since they
+were at war with the Algonquins and regarded us as their friends. In view
+of this I set out as soon as possible, and visited on my way the Nipissings
+to ascertain when they would be ready for the journey to the north, which I
+found broken off on account of these quarrels and hostilities, as my
+interpreter gave me to understand, who said that Captain Yroquet had come
+among all these tribes to find and await me. He had requested them to be at
+the habitation of the French at the same time with himself to see what
+agreement could be made between them and the Atignouaatitans, and to
+postpone the journey to the north to another time. Moreover, Yroquet had
+given porcelain to break off this journey. They promised us to be at our
+habitation at the same time as the others.
+
+If ever there was one greatly disheartened it was myself, since I had been
+waiting to see this year what during many preceding ones I had been seeking
+for with great toil and effort, through so many fatigues and risks of my
+life. But realizing that I could not help the matter, and that everything
+depended on the will of God, I comforted myself, resolving to see it in a
+short time. I had such sure information that I could not doubt the report
+of these people, who go to traffic with others dwelling in those northern
+regions, a great part of whom live in a place very abundant in the chase,
+and where there are great numbers of large animals, the skins of several of
+which I saw, and which I concluded were buffaloes [180] from their
+representation of their form. Fishing is also very abundant there. This
+journey requires forty days, as well in returning as in going.
+
+I set out towards our above-mentioned village on the 15th of February,
+taking with me six of our men. Having arrived at that place the inhabitants
+were greatly pleased, as also the Algonquins, whom I sent our interpreter
+to visit in order to ascertain how everything had taken place on both
+sides, for I did not wish to go myself that I might give no ground for
+suspicion to either party.
+
+Two days were spent in hearing from both sides how everything had taken
+place. After this the principal men and seniors of the place came away with
+us, and we all together went to the Algonquins. Here in one of their
+cabins, where several of the leading men were assembled, they all, after
+some talk, agreed to come and accept all that might be said by me as
+arbiter in the matter, and to carry out what I might propose.
+
+Then I gathered the views of each one, obtaining and investigating the
+wishes and inclinations of both parties, and ascertained that all they
+wanted was peace.
+
+I set forth to them that the best course was to become reconciled and
+remain friends, since being united and bound together they could the more
+easily withstand their enemies; and as I went away I begged them not to ask
+me to effect their reconciliation if they did not intend to follow in all
+respects the advice I should give them in regard to this dispute, since
+they had done me the honor to request my opinion. Whereupon they told me
+anew that they had not desired my return for any other reason. I for my
+part thought that if I should not reconcile and pacify them they would
+separate ill disposed towards each other, each party thinking itself in the
+right. I reflected, also, that they would not have gone to their cabins if
+I had not been with them, nor to the French if I had not interested myself
+and taken, so to speak, the charge and conduct of their affairs. Upon this
+I said to them that as for myself I proposed to go with my host, who had
+always treated me well, and that I could with difficulty find one so good;
+for it was on him that the Algonquins laid the blame, saying that he was
+the only captain who had caused the taking up of arms. Much was said by
+both sides, and finally it was concluded that I should tell them what
+seemed to me best, and give them my advice.
+
+Since I saw now from what was said that they referred the whole matter to
+my own decision as to that of a father, and promised that in the future I
+might dispose of them as I thought best, referring the whole matter to my
+judgment for settlement, I replied that I was very glad to see them so
+inclined to follow my advice, and assured them that it should be only for
+the best interests of the tribes.
+
+Moreover I told them, I had been greatly disturbed at hearing the further
+sad intelligence, namely the death of one of their relatives and friends,
+whom we regarded as one of our own, which might have caused a great
+calamity resulting in nothing but perpetual wars between both parties, with
+various and serious disasters and a rupture of their friendship, in
+consequence of which the French would be deprived of seeing them and of
+intercourse with them, and be obliged to enter into alliance with other
+nations; since we loved each other as brothers, leaving to God the
+punishment of those meriting it.
+
+I proceeded to say to them, that this mode of action between two nations,
+who were, as they acknowledged, friendly to each other, was unworthy of
+reasoning men, but rather characteristic of brute beasts. I represented to
+them, moreover, that they were enough occupied in repelling their enemies
+who pursued them, in routing them as often as possible, in pursuing them to
+their villages and taking them prisoners; and that these enemies, seeing
+divisions and wars among them, would be delighted and derive great
+advantage therefrom; and be led to lay new and pernicious plans, in the
+hope of soon being able to see their ruin, or at least their enfeebling
+through one another, which would be the truest and easiest way for them to
+conquer and become masters of their territories, since they did not assist
+each other.
+
+I told them likewise that they did not realize the harm that might befall
+them from thus acting; that on account of the death of one man they
+hazarded the lives of ten thousand, and ran the risk of being reduced to
+perpetual slavery; that, although in fact one man was of great value, yet
+they ought to consider how he had been killed, and that it was not with
+deliberate purpose, nor for the sake of inciting a civil war, it being only
+too evident that the dead man had first offended, since with deliberate
+purpose he had killed the prisoner in their cabins, a most audacious thing,
+even if the latter were an enemy. This aroused the Algonquins, who, seeing
+a man that had been so bold as to kill in their own cabins another to whom
+they had given liberty and treated as one of themselves, were carried away
+with passion; and some, more excited than the rest, advanced, and, unable
+to restrain or control their wrath, killed the man in question.
+Nevertheless they had no ill feeling at all towards the nation as a whole,
+and did not extend their purposes beyond the audacious one, who, they
+thought, fully deserved what he had wantonly earned.
+
+And besides I told them they must confider that the Entouhonoron, finding
+himself wounded by two blows in the stomach, tore from his wound the knife
+which his enemy had left there and gave the latter two blows, as I had been
+informed; so that in fact one could not tell whether it was really the
+Algonquins who had committed the murder. And in order to show to the
+Attigouantans that the Algonquins did not love the prisoner, and that
+Yroquet did not bear towards him the affection which they were disposed to
+think, I reminded them that they had eaten him, as he had inflicted blows
+with a knife upon his enemy; a thing, however, unworthy of a human being,
+but rather characteristic of brute beasts.
+
+I told them also that the Algonquins very much regretted all that had taken
+place, and that, if they had supposed such a thing would have happened,
+they would have sacrificed this Iroquois for their satisfaction. I reminded
+them likewise that they had made recompense for this death and offence, if
+so it should be called, by large presents and two prisoners, on which
+account they had no reason at present to complain, and ought to restrain
+themselves and act more mildly towards the Algonquins, their friends. I
+told them that, since they had promised to submit every thing to
+arbitration, I entreated them to forget all that had passed between them
+and never to think of it again, nor bear any hatred or ill will on account
+of it to each other, but to live good friends as before, by doing which
+they would constrain us to love them and assist them as I had done in the
+past. But in case they should not be pleased with my advice, I requested
+them to come, in as large numbers as possible, to our settlement, so that
+there, in the presence of all the captains of vessels, our friendship might
+be ratified anew, and measures taken to secure them from their enemies, a
+thing which they ought to consider.
+
+Then they began to say that I had spoken well, and that they would adhere
+to what I had said, and all went away to their cabins, apparently
+satisfied, excepting the Algonquins, who broke up and proceeded to their
+village, but who, as it seemed to me, appeared to be not entirely
+satisfied, since they said among themselves that they would not come to
+winter again in these places, the death of these two men having cost them
+too dearly. As for myself, I returned to my host, in whom I endeavored to
+inspire all the courage I could, in order to induce him to come to our
+settlement, and bring with him all those of his country.
+
+During the winter, which lasted four months, I had sufficient leisure to
+observe their country, customs, dress, manner of living, the character of
+their assemblies, and other things which I should like to describe. But it
+is necessary first to speak of the situation of the country in general and
+its divisions, also of the location of the tribes and the distances between
+them.
+
+The country extends in length, in the direction from east to west, nearly
+four hundred and fifty leagues, and some eighty or a hundred leagues in
+breadth from north to south, from latitude 41 deg. to 48 deg. or 49 deg. [181] This
+region is almost an island, surrounded by the great river Saint Lawrence,
+which passes through several lakes of great extent, on the shores of which
+dwell various tribes speaking different languages, having fixed abodes, and
+all fond of the cultivation of the soil, but with various modes of life,
+and customs, some better than others. On the shore north of this great
+river, extending westerly some hundred leagues towards the Attigouantans,
+[182] there are very high mountains, and the air is more temperate than in
+any other part of these regions, the latitude being 41 deg.. All these places
+abound in game, such as stags, caribous, elks, does, [183] buffaloes,
+bears, wolves, beavers, foxes, minxes, [184] weasels, [185] and many other
+kinds of animals which we do not have in France. Fishing is abundant, there
+being many varieties, both those which we have in France, as also others
+which we have not. There are likewise many birds in their time and season.
+The country is traversed by numerous rivers, brooks, and ponds, connecting
+with each other and finally emptying into the river St. Lawrence and the
+lakes through which it passes. The country is very pleasant in spring, is
+covered with extensive and lofty forests, and filled with wood similar to
+that which we have in France, although in many places there is much cleared
+land, where they plant Indian corn. This region also abounds in meadows,
+lowlands, and marshes, which furnish food for the animals before mentioned.
+
+The country north of the great river is very rough and mountainous, and
+extends in latitude from 47 deg. to 49 deg., and in places abounds in rocks. [186]
+So far as I could make out, these regions are inhabited by savages, who
+wander through the country, not engaging in the cultivation of the soil,
+nor doing anything, or at least as good as nothing. But they are hunters,
+now in one place, now in another, the region being very cold and
+disagreeable. This land on the north is in latitude 49º and extends over
+six hundred leagues in breadth from east to west, of parts of which we have
+full knowledge. There are also many fine large rivers rising in this region
+and discharging into the before-mentioned river, together with an infinite
+number of fine meadows, lakes, and ponds, through which they pass, where
+there is an abundance of fish. There are likewise numerous islands which
+are for the most part cleared up and very pleasant, the most of them
+containing great quantities of vines and wild fruits.
+
+With regard to the regions further west, we cannot well determine their
+extent, since the people here have no knowledge of them except for two or
+three hundred leagues or more westerly, from whence comes the great river,
+which passes, among other places, through a lake having an extent of nearly
+thirty days' journey by canoe, namely that which we have called the _Mer
+Douce_. This is of great extent, being nearly four hundred leagues long.
+Inasmuch as the savages, with whom we are on friendly terms, are at war
+with other nations on the west of this great lake, we cannot obtain a more
+complete knowledge of them, except as they have told us several times that
+some prisoners from the distance of a hundred leagues had reported that
+there were tribes there like ourselves in color and in other respects.
+Through them they have seen the hair of these people which is very light,
+and which they esteem highly, saying that it is like our own. I can only
+conjecture in regard to this, that the people they say resemble us were
+those more civilized than themselves. It would require actual presence to
+ascertain the truth in regard to this matter. But assistance is needed, and
+it is only men of means, leisure, and energy, who could or would undertake
+to promote this enterprise so that a full exploration of these places might
+be made, affording us a complete knowledge of them.
+
+In regard to the region south of the great river it is very thickly
+settled, much more so than that on the north, and by tribes who are at war
+with each other. The country is very pleasant, much more so than that on
+the northern border, and the air is more temperate. There are many kinds of
+trees and fruits not found north of the river, while there are many things
+on the north side, in compensation, not found on the south. The regions
+towards the east are sufficiently well known, inasmuch as the ocean borders
+these places. These are the coasts of Labrador, Newfoundland, Cape Breton,
+La Cadie, and the Almouchiquois, [187] places well known, as I have treated
+of them sufficiently in the narrative of my previous Voyages, as likewise
+of the people living there, on which account I shall not speak of them in
+this treatise, my object being only to make a succinct and true report of
+what I have seen in addition.
+
+The country of the nation of the Attigouantans is in latitude 44 deg. 30', and
+extends two hundred and thirty leagues [188] in length westerly, and ten in
+breadth. It contains eighteen villages, six of which are enclosed and
+fortified by palisades of wood in triple rows, bound together, on the top
+of which are galleries, which they provide with stones and water; the
+former to hurl upon their enemies and the latter to extinguish the fire
+which their enemies may set to the palisades. The country is pleasant, most
+of it cleared up. It has the shape of Brittany, and is similarly situated,
+being almost surrounded by the _Mer Douce_ [189] They assume that these
+eighteen villages are inhabited by two thousand warriors, not including the
+common mass which amounts to perhaps thirty thousand souls.
+
+Their cabins are in the shape of tunnels or arbors, and are covered with
+the bark of trees. They are from twenty-five to thirty fathoms long, more
+or less, and six wide, having a passage-way through the middle from ten to
+twelve feet wide, which extends from one end to the other. On the two sides
+there is a kind of bench, four feet high, where they sleep in summer, in
+order to avoid the annoyance of the fleas, of which there are great
+numbers. In winter they sleep on the ground on mats near the fire, so as to
+be warmer than they would be on the platform. They lay up a stock of dry
+wood, with which they fill their cabins, to burn in winter. At the
+extremity of the cabins there is a space, where they preserve their Indian
+corn, which they put into great casks made of the bark of trees and placed
+in the middle of their encampment. They have pieces of wood suspended, on
+which they put their clothes, provisions, and other things, for fear of the
+mice, of which there are great numbers. In one of these cabins there may be
+twelve fires, and twenty-four families. It smokes excessively, from which
+it follows that many receive serious injury to the eyes, so that they lose
+their sight towards the close of life. There is no window nor any opening,
+except that in the upper part of their cabins for the smoke to escape.
+
+This is all that I have been able to learn about their mode of life; and I
+have described to you fully the kind of dwelling of these people, as far as
+I have been able to learn it, which is the same as that of all the tribes
+living in these regions. They sometimes change their villages at intervals
+of ten, twenty, or thirty years, and transfer them to a distance of one,
+two, or three leagues from the preceding situation, [190] except when
+compelled by their enemies to dislodge, in which case they retire to a
+greater distance, as the Antouhonorons, who went some forty to fifty
+leagues. This is the form of their dwellings, which are separated from each
+other some three or four paces, for fear of fire, of which they are in
+great dread.
+
+Their life is a miserable one in comparison with our own; but they are
+happy among themselves, not having experienced anything better, and not
+imagining that anything more excellent is to be found. Their principal
+articles of food are Indian corn and Brazilian beans, [191] which they
+prepare in various ways. By braying in a wooden mortar they reduce the corn
+to meal. They remove the bran by means of fans made of the bark of trees.
+From this meal they make bread, using also beans which they first boil, as
+they do the Indian corn for soup, so that they may be more easily crushed.
+Then they mix all together, sometimes adding blueberries [192] or dry
+raspberries, and sometimes pieces of deer's fat, though not often, as this
+is scarce with them. After steeping the whole in lukewarm water, they make
+bread in the form of bannocks or pies, which they bake in the ashes. After
+they are baked they wash them, and from these they often make others by
+wrapping them in corn leaves, which they fasten to them, and then putting
+them in boiling water.
+
+But this is not their most common kind. They make another, which they call
+_migan_, which is as follows: They take the pounded Indian corn, without
+removing the bran, and put two or three handfuls of it in an earthen pot
+full of water. This they boil, stirring it from time to time, that it may
+not burn nor adhere to the pot. Then they put into the pot a small quantity
+of fish, fresh or dry, according to the season, to give a flavor to the
+_migan_, as they call it. They make it very often, although it smells
+badly, especially in winter, either because they do not know how to prepare
+it rightly, or do not wish to take the trouble to do so. They make two
+kinds of it, and prepare it very well when they choose. When they use fish
+the _migan_ does not smell badly, but only when it is made with
+venison. After it is all cooked, they take out the fish, pound it very
+fine, and then put it all together into the pot, not taking the trouble to
+remove the appendages, scales, or inwards, as we do, which generally causes
+a bad taste. It being thus prepared, they deal out to each one his
+portion. This _migan_ is very thin, and without much substance, as may be
+well supposed. As for drink, there is no need of it, the _migan_ being
+sufficiently thin of itself.
+
+They have another kind of _migan_, namely, they roast new corn before it is
+ripe, which they preserve and cook whole with fish, or flesh when they have
+it. Another way is this: they take Indian corn, which is very dry, roast it
+in the ashes, then bray it and reduce it to meal as in the former case.
+This they lay up for the journeys which they undertake here and there. The
+_migan_ made in the latter manner is the best according to my taste. Figure
+H shows the women braying their Indian corn. In preparing it, they cook a
+large quantity of fish and meat, which they cut into pieces and put into
+great kettles, which they fill with water and let it all boil well. When
+this is done, they gather with a spoon from the surface the fat which comes
+from the meat and fish. Then they put in the meal of the roasted corn,
+constantly stirring it until the _migan_ is cooked and thick as soup. They
+give to each one a portion, together with a spoonful of the fat. This dish
+they are accustomed to prepare for banquets, but they do not generally make
+it.
+
+Now the corn freshly roasted, as above described, is highly esteemed among
+them. They eat also beans, which they boil with the mass of the roasted
+flour, mixing in a little fat and fish. Dogs are in request at their
+banquets, which they often celebrate among themselves, especially in
+winter, when they are at leisure. In case they go hunting for deer or go
+fishing, they lay aside what they get for celebrating these banquets,
+nothing remaining in their cabins but the usual thin _migan_, resembling
+bran and water, such as is given to hogs to eat.
+
+They have another way of eating the Indian corn. In preparing it, they take
+it in the ear and put it in water under the mud, leaving it two or three
+months in this state until they think it is putrefied. Then they remove it,
+and eat it boiled with meat or fish. They also roast it, and it is better
+so than boiled. But I assure you that there is nothing that smells so badly
+as this corn as it comes from the water all muddy. Yet the women and
+children take it and suck it like sugar-cane, nothing seeming to them to
+taste better, as they show by their manner. In general they have two meals
+a day. As for ourselves, we fasted all of Lent and longer, in order to
+influence them by our example. But it was time lost.
+
+They also fatten bears, which they keep two or three years, for the purpose
+of their banquets. I observed that if this people had domestic animals they
+would be interested in them and care for them very well, and I showed them
+the way to keep them, which would be an easy thing for them, since they
+have good grazing grounds in their country, and in large quantities, for
+all kinds of animals, horses, oxen, cows, sheep, swine, and other kinds,
+for lack of which one would consider them badly off, as they seem to be.
+Yet with all their drawbacks, they seem to me to live happily among
+themselves, since their only ambition is to live and support themselves,
+and they lead a more settled life than those who wander through the forests
+like brute beasts. They eat many squashes, [193] which they boil, and roast
+in the ashes.
+
+In regard to their dress, they have various kinds and styles made of the
+skins of wild beasts, both those which they capture themselves, and others
+which they get in exchange for their Indian corn, meal, porcelain, and
+fishing-nets from the Algonquins, Nipissings, and other tribes, which are
+hunters having no fixed abodes. All their clothes are of one uniform shape,
+not varied by any new styles. They prepare and fit very well the skins,
+making their breeches of deer-skin rather large, and their stockings of
+another piece, which extend up to the middle and have many folds. Their
+shoes are made of the skins of deer, bears, and beaver, of which they use
+great numbers. Besides, they have a robe of the same fur, in the form of a
+cloak, which they wear in the Irish or Egyptian style, with sleeves which
+are attached with a string behind. This is the way they are dressed in
+winter, as is seen in figure D. When they go into the fields, they gird up
+their robe about the body; but when in the village, they leave off their
+sleeves and do not gird themselves. The Milan trimmings for decorating
+their garments are made of glue and the scrapings of the before-mentioned
+skins, of which they make bands in various styles according to their fancy,
+putting in places bands of red and brown color amid those of the glue,
+which always keep a whitish appearance, not losing at all their shape,
+however dirty they may get. There are those among these nations who are
+much more skilful than others in fitting the skins, and ingenious in
+inventing ornaments to put on their garments. It is our Montagnais and
+Algonquins, above all others, who take more pains in this matter. They put
+on their robes bands of porcupine quills, which they dye a very fine
+scarlet color. [194] They value these bands very highly, and detach them so
+that they may serve for other robes when they wish to make a change. They
+also make use of them to adorn the face, in order to give it a more
+graceful appearance whenever they wish particularly to decorate themselves.
+
+Most of them paint the face black and red. These colors they mix with oil
+made from the seed of the sun-flower, or with bear's fat or that of other
+animals. They also dye their hair, which some wear long, others short,
+others on one side only. The women and girls always wear their hair in one
+uniform style. They are dressed like men, except that they always have
+their robes girt about them, which extend down to the knee. They are not at
+all ashamed to expose the body from the middle up and from the knees down,
+unlike the men, the rest being always covered. They are loaded with
+quantities of porcelain, in the shape of necklaces and chains, which they
+arrange in the front of their robes and attach to their waists. They also
+wear bracelets and ear-rings. They have their hair carefully combed, dyed,
+and oiled. Thus they go to the dance, with a knot of their hair behind
+bound up with eel-skin, which they use as a cord. Sometimes they put on
+plates a foot square, covered with porcelain, which hang on the back. Thus
+gaily dressed and habited, they delight to appear in the dance, to which
+their fathers and mothers send them, forgetting nothing that they can
+devise to embellish and set off their daughters. I can testify that I have
+seen at dances a girl who had more than twelve pounds of porcelain on her
+person, not including the other bagatelles with which they are loaded and
+bedecked. In the illustration already cited, F shows the dress of the
+women, G that of the girls attired for the dance.
+
+All these people have a very jovial disposition, although there are many of
+them who have a sad and gloomy look. Their bodies are well proportioned.
+Some of the men and women are well formed, strong, and robust. There is a
+moderate number of pleasing and pretty girls, in respect to figure, color,
+and expression, all being in harmony. Their blood is but little
+deteriorated, except when they are old. There are among these tribes
+powerful women of extraordinary height These have almost the entire care of
+the house and work; namely, they till the land, plant the Indian corn, lay
+up a store of wood for the winter, beat the hemp and spin it, making from
+the thread fishing-nets and other useful things. The women harvest the
+corn, house it, prepare it for eating, and attend to household matters.
+Moreover they are expected to attend their husbands from place to place in
+the fields, filling the office of pack-mule in carrying the baggage, and to
+do a thousand other things. All the men do is to hunt for deer and other
+animals, fish, make their cabins, and go to war. Having done these things,
+they then go to other tribes with which they are acquainted to traffic and
+make exchanges. On their return, they give themselves up to festivities and
+dances, which they give to each other, and when these are over they go to
+sleep, which they like to do best of all things.
+
+They have some sort of marriage, which is as follows: when a girl has
+reached the age of eleven, twelve, thirteen, fourteen, or fifteen years she
+has suitors, more or less according to her attractions, who woo her for
+some time. After this, the consent of their fathers and mothers is asked,
+to whose will the girls often do not submit, although the most discreet and
+considerate do so. The lover or suitor presents to the girl some necklaces,
+chains, and bracelets of porcelain. If the girl finds the suitor agreeable,
+she receives the present. Then the lover comes and remains with her three
+or four nights, without saying anything to her during the time. They
+receive thus the fruit of their affections. Whence it happens very often
+that, after from eight to fifteen days, if they cannot agree, she quits her
+suitor, who forfeits his necklaces and other presents that he has made,
+having received in return only a meagre satisfaction. Being thus
+disappointed in his hopes, the man seeks another woman, and the girl
+another suitor, if it seems to them desirable. Thus they continue to do
+until a favorable union is formed. It sometimes happens that a girl thus
+passes her entire youth, having more than twenty mates, which twenty are
+not alone in the enjoyment of the creature, mated though they are; for when
+night comes the young women run from one cabin to another, as do also the
+young men on their part, going where it seems good to them, but always
+without any violence, referring the whole matter to the pleasure of the
+woman. Their mates will do likewise to their women-neighbors, no jealousy
+arising among them on that account, nor do they incur any reproach or
+insult, such being the custom of the country.
+
+Now the time when they do not leave their mates is when they have
+children. The preceding mate returns to her, renews the affection and
+friendship which he had borne her in the past, asserting that it is greater
+than that of any other one, and that the child she has is his and of his
+begetting. The next says the same to her. In time, the victory is with the
+stronger, who takes the woman for his wife. Thus it depends upon the
+choice of the woman to take and accept him who shall please her best,
+having meantime in her searching and loves gained much porcelain and,
+besides, the choice of a husband. The woman remains with him without
+leaving him; or if she do leave him, for he is on trial, it must be for
+some good reason other than impotence. But while with this husband, she
+does not cease to give herself free rein, yet remains always at home,
+keeping up a good appearance. Thus the children which they have together,
+born from such a woman, cannot be sure of their legitimacy. Accordingly, in
+view of this uncertainty, it is their custom that the children never
+succeed to the property and honors of their fathers, there being doubt, as
+above indicated, as to their paternity. They make, however, the children of
+their sisters, from whom they are known to have issued, their successors
+and heirs.
+
+The following is the way they nourish and bring up their children: they
+place them during the day on a little wooden board, wrapping them up in
+furs or skins. To this board they bind them, placing them in an erect
+position, and leaving a little opening for the child to do its necessities.
+If it is a girl, they put a leaf of Indian corn between the thighs, which
+presses against its privates. The extremity of the leaf is carried outside
+in a turned position, so that the water of the child runs off on it without
+inconvenience. They put also under the children the down of certain reeds
+that we call hare's-foot, on which they rest very softly. They also clean
+them with the same down. As an ornament for the child, they adorn the board
+with beads, which they also put on its neck, however small it may be. At
+night they put it to bed, entirely naked, between the father and mother. It
+may be regarded as a great miracle that God should thus preserve it so that
+no harm befalls it, as might be expected, from suffocation, while the
+father and mother are in deep sleep, but that rarely happens. The children
+have great freedom among these tribes. The fathers and mothers indulge them
+too much, and never punish them. Accordingly they are so bad and of so
+vicious a nature, that they often strike their mothers and others. The most
+vicious, when they have acquired the strength and power, strike their
+fathers. They do this whenever the father or mother does anything that
+does not please them. This is a sort of curse that God inflicts upon them.
+
+In respect to laws, I have not been able to find out that they have any, or
+anything that approaches them, inasmuch as there is not among them any
+correction, punishment, or censure of evil-doers except in the way of
+vengeance, when they return evil for evil, not by rule but by passion,
+which produces among them conflicts and differences, which occur very
+frequently.
+
+Moreover, they do not recognize any divinity, or worship any God and
+believe in anything whatever, but live like brute beasts. They have,
+however, some respect for the devil, or something so called, which is a
+matter of uncertainty, since the word which they use thus has various
+significations and comprises in itself various things. It is accordingly
+difficult to determine whether they mean the devil or something else, but
+what especially leads to the belief that what they mean is the devil is
+this: whenever they see a man doing something extraordinary, or who is more
+capable than usual, or is a valiant warrior, or furthermore who is in a
+rage as if out of his reason and senses, they call him _oqui_, or, as we
+should say, a great knowing spirit, or a great devil. However this may be,
+they have certain persons, who are the _oqui_, or, as the Algonquins and
+Montagnais call them, _manitous_; and persons of this kind are the
+medicine-men, who heal the sick, bind up the wounded, and predict future
+events, who in fine practise all abuses and illusions of the devil to
+deceive and delude them. These _oquis_ or conjurers persuade their patients
+and the sick to make, or have made banquets and ceremonies that they may be
+the sooner healed, their object being to participate in them finally
+themselves and get the principal benefit therefrom. Under the pretence of a
+more speedy cure, they likewise cause them to observe various other
+ceremonies, which I shall hereafter speak of in the proper place. These
+are the people in whom they put especial confidence, but it is rare that
+they are possessed of the devil and tormented like other savages living
+more remote than themselves.
+
+This gives additional reason and ground to believe that their conversion to
+the knowledge of God would be more easy, if their country were inhabited by
+persons who would take the trouble and pains to instruct them. But it is
+not enough to send to them friars, unless there are those to support and
+assist them. For although these people have the desire to-day to know what
+God is, to-morrow this disposition will change when they are obliged to lay
+aside and bring under their foul ways, their dissolute manners, and their
+savage indulgences. So that there is need of people and families to keep
+them in the way of duty, to constrain them through mildness to do better,
+and to move them by good example to mend their lives. Father Joseph [195]
+and myself have many times conferred with them in regard to our belief,
+laws, and customs. They listened attentively in their assemblies, sometimes
+saying to us: You say things that pass our knowledge, and which we cannot
+understand by words, being beyond our comprehension; but if you would do us
+a service come and dwell in this country, bringing your wives and children,
+and when they are here we shall see how you serve the God you worship, and
+how you live with your wives and children, how you cultivate and plant the
+soil, how you obey your laws, how you take care of animals, and how you
+manufacture all that we see proceeding from your inventive skill. When we
+see all this, we shall learn more in a year than in twenty by simply
+hearing you discourse and if we cannot then understand, you shall take our
+children, who shall be as your own. And thus being convinced that our life
+is a miserable one in comparison with yours, it is easy to believe that we
+shall adopt yours, abandoning our own.
+
+Their words seemed to me good common sense, showing the desire they have to
+get a knowledge of God. It is a great wrong to let so many men be lost, and
+see them perish at our door, without rendering them the succor which can
+only be given through the help of kings, princes, and ecclesiastics, who
+alone have the power to do this. For to them alone belongs the honor of so
+great a work; namely, planting the Christian faith in an unknown region and
+among savage nations, since we are well informed about these people, that
+they long for and desire nothing so much as to be clearly instructed as to
+what they should do and avoid. It is accordingly the duty of those who have
+the power, to labor there and contribute of their abundance, for one day
+they must answer before God for the loss of the souls which they allowed to
+perish through their negligence and avarice; and these are not few but very
+numerous. Now this will be done when it shall please God to give them grace
+to this end. As for myself, I desire this result rather to-day than
+to-morrow, from the zeal which I have for the advancement of God's glory,
+for the honor of my King, and for the welfare and renown of my country.
+
+When they are sick, the man or woman who is attacked with any disease sends
+for the _oqui_, who visits the patient and informs himself about the malady
+and the suffering. After this, the _oqui_ sends for a large number of men,
+women, and girls, including three or four old women. These enter the cabin
+of the sick, dancing, each one having on his head the skin of a bear or
+some other wild beast, that of the bear being the most common as it is the
+most frightful. There are three or four other old women about the sick or
+suffering, who for the most part feign sickness, or are sick merely in
+imagination. But they are soon cured of this sickness, and generally make
+banquets at the expense of their friends or relatives, who give them
+something to put into their kettle, in addition to the presents which they
+receive from the dancers, such as porcelain and other bagatelles, so that
+they are soon cured; for when they find that they have nothing more to look
+for, they get up with what they have secured. But those who are really sick
+are not readily cured by plays, dances, and such proceedings.
+
+To return to my narrative: the old women near the sick person receive the
+presents, each singing and pausing in turn. When all the presents have been
+made, they proceed to lift up their voices with one accord, all singing
+together and keeping time with sticks on pieces of dry bark. Then all the
+women and girls proceed to the end of the cabin, as if they were about to
+begin a ballet or masquerade. The old women walk in front with their
+bearskins on their heads, all the others following them, one after the
+other. They have only two kinds of dances with regular time, one of four
+steps and the other of twelve, as in the _trioli_ de Bretagne. They
+exhibit much grace in dancing. Young men often take part with them. After
+dancing an hour or two, the old women lead out the sick person to dance,
+who gets up dolefully and prepares to dance, and after a short time she
+dances and enjoys as much as the others. I leave it to you to consider how
+sick she was. Below is represented the mode of their dances.
+
+The medicine-man thus gains honor and credit, his patient being so soon
+healed and on her feet. This treatment, however, does nothing for those who
+are dangerously ill and reduced by weakness, but causes their death rather
+than their cure; for I can testify that they sometimes make such a noise
+and hubbub from morning until two o'clock at night that it is impossible
+for the patient to endure it without great pain. Sometimes the patient is
+seized with the desire to have the women and girls dance all together,
+which is done in accordance with the direction of the _oqui_. But this is
+not all, for he and the _manitou_, accompanied by some others, make
+grimaces, perform magic arts, and twist themselves about so that they
+generally end in being out of their senses, seemingly crazy, throwing the
+fire from one side of the cabin to the other, eating burning coals, holding
+them in their hands for a while, and throwing red-hot ashes into the eyes
+of the spectators. Seeing them in this condition, one would say that the
+devil, the _oqui_, or _manitou_, if he is thus to be called, possesses and
+torments them. This noise and hubbub being over, they retire each to his
+own cabin.
+
+But those who suffer especially during this time are the wives of those
+possessed, and all the inmates of their cabins, from the fear they have
+lest the raging ones burn up all that is in their houses. This leads them
+to remove everything that is in sight; for as soon as he arrives he is all
+in a fury, his eyes flashing and frightful, sometimes standing up,
+sometimes seated, as his fancy takes him. Suddenly a fit seizes him, and
+laying hold of everything he finds in his way he throws them to one side
+and the other. Then he lies down and sleeps for some time. Waking up with a
+jump, he seizes fire and stones which he throws about recklessly on all
+sides. This rage passes off with the sleep which seizes him again. Then he
+rages and calls several of his friends to sweat with him. The latter is the
+best means they have for preserving themselves in health. While they are
+sweating, the kettle boils to prepare them something to eat They remain,
+two or three hours or so, covered up with great pieces of bark and wrapped
+in their robes, with a great many stones about them which have been heated
+red hot in the fire. They sing all the time while they are in the rage,
+occasionally stopping to take breath. Then they give them many draughts of
+water to drink, since they are very thirsty, when the demoniac, who was
+crazy or possessed of an evil spirit, becomes sober.
+
+Thus it happens that three or four of these sick persons get well, rather
+by a happy coincidence and chance than in consequence of any intelligent
+treatment, and this confirms their false belief that they are healed by
+means of these ceremonies, not considering that, for two who are thus
+cured, ten others die on account of the noise, great hubbub and hissing,
+which are rather calculated to kill than cure a sick person. But that they
+expect to recover their health by this noise, and we on the contrary by
+silence and rest, shows how the devil does everything in hostility to the
+good.
+
+There are also women who go into these rages, but they do not do so much
+harm. They walk on all fours like beasts. Seeing this, the magician, called
+_oqui_, begins to sing; then, with some contortions of the face, he blows
+upon her, directing her to drink certain waters, and make at once a banquet
+of fish or flesh, which must be procured although very scarce at the
+time. When the shouting is over and the banquet ended, they return each to
+her own cabin. At another time he comes back and visits her, blowing upon
+her and singing in company with several others, who have been summoned for
+this purpose, and who hold in the hand a dry tortoise-shell filled with
+little pebbles, which they cause to resound in the ears of the sick woman.
+They direct her to make at once three or four banquets with singing and
+dancing, when all the girls appear adorned and painted as I have
+represented in figure G. The _oqui_ orders masquerades, and directs them to
+disguise themselves, as those do who run along the streets in France on
+_Mardi-gras_. [196] Thus they go and sing near the bed of the sick woman
+and promenade through the village while the banquet is preparing to receive
+the maskers, who return very tired, having taken exercise enough to be able
+to empty the kettle of its _migan_.
+
+According to their custom each household lives on what it gets by fishing
+and planting, improving as much land as it needs. They clear it up with
+great difficulty, since they do not have the implements adapted to this
+purpose. A party strip the trees of all their branches, which they burn at
+their base in order to kill them. They clear carefully the land between the
+trees, and then plant their corn at distances of a pace, putting in each
+place some ten kernels, and so on until they have made provision for three
+or four years, fearing that a bad year may befall them. The women attend to
+the planting and harvesting, as I have said before, and to procuring a
+supply of wood for winter. All the women aid each other in procuring this
+provision of wood, which they do in the month of March or April, in the
+order of two days for each. Every household is provided with as much as it
+needs; and if a girl marries, each woman and girl is expected to carry to
+the newly married one a parcel of wood for her provision, since she could
+not procure it alone, and at a season when she has to give her attention to
+other things.
+
+The following is their mode of government: the older and leading men
+assemble in a council, in which they settle upon and propose all that is
+necessary for the affairs of the village. This is done by a plurality of
+voices, or in accordance with the advice of some one among them whose
+judgment they consider superior: such a one is requested by the company to
+give his opinion on the propositions that have been made, and this opinion
+is minutely obeyed. They have no particular chiefs with absolute command,
+but they show honor to the older and more courageous men, whom they name
+captains, as mark of honor and respect, of which there are several in a
+village. But, although they confer more honor upon one than upon others,
+yet he is not on that account to bear sway, nor esteem himself higher than
+his companions, unless he does so from vanity. They make no use of
+punishments nor arbitrary command, but accomplish everything by the
+entreaties of the seniors, and by means of addresses and remonstrances.
+Thus and not otherwise do they bring everything to pass.
+
+They all deliberate in common, and whenever any member of the assembly
+offers to do anything for the welfare of the village, or to go anywhere for
+the service of the community, he is requested to present himself, and if he
+is judged capable of carrying out what he proposes, they exhort him, by
+fair and favorable words, to do his duty. They declare him to be an
+energetic man, fit for undertakings, and allure him that he will win honor
+in accomplishing them. In a word, they encourage him by flatteries, in
+order that this favorable disposition of his for the welfare of his fellow-
+citizens may continue and increase. Then, according to his pleasure, he
+refuses the responsibility, which few do, or accepts, since thereby he is
+held in high esteem.
+
+When they engage in wars or go to the country of their enemies, two or
+three of the older or valiant captains make a beginning in the matter, and
+proceed to the adjoining villages to communicate their purpose, and make
+presents to the people of these villages, in order to induce them to
+accompany them to the wars in question. In so far they act as generals of
+armies. They designate the place where they desire to go, dispose of the
+prisoners who are captured, and have the direction of other matters of
+especial importance, of which they get the honor, if they are successful;
+but, if not, the disgrace of failure in the war falls upon them. These
+captains alone are looked upon and considered as chiefs of the tribes.
+
+They have, moreover, general assemblies, with representatives from remote
+regions. These representatives come every year, one from each province, and
+meet in a town designated as the rendezvous of the assembly. Here are
+celebrated great banquets and dances, for three weeks or a month, according
+as they may determine. Here they renew their friendship, resolve upon and
+decree what they think best for the preservation of their country against
+their enemies, and make each other handsome presents, after which they
+retire each to his own district.
+
+In burying the dead, they take the body of the deceased, wrap it in furs,
+and cover it very carefully with the bark of trees. Then they place it in a
+cabin, of the length of the body, made of bark and erected upon four posts.
+Others they place in the ground, propping up the earth on all sides, that
+it may not fall on the body, which they cover with the bark of trees,
+putting earth on top. Over this trench they also make a little cabin. Now
+it is to be understood that the bodies remain in these places, thus
+inhumed, but for a period of eight or ten years, when the men of the
+village recommend the place where their ceremonies are to take place; or,
+to speak more precisely, they hold a general council, in which all the
+people of the country are present, for the purpose of designating the place
+where a festival is to be held. After this they return each to his own
+village, where they take all the bones of the deceased, strip them and make
+them quite clean. These they keep very carefully, although they smell like
+bodies recently interred. Then all the relatives and friends of the
+deceased take these bones, together with their necklaces, furs, axes,
+kettles, and other things highly valued, and carry them, with a quantity of
+edibles, to the place assigned. Here, when all have assembled, they put the
+edibles in a place designated by the men of the village, and engage in
+banquets and continual dancing. The festival continues for the space of ten
+days, during which time other tribes, from all quarters, come to witness it
+and the ceremonies. The latter are attended with great outlays.
+
+Now, by means of these ceremonies, including dances, banquets, and
+assemblies, as above stated, they renew their friendship to one another,
+saying that the bones of their relatives and friends are to be all put
+together, thus indicating by a figure that, as their bones are gathered
+together and united in one and the same place, so ought they also, during
+their life, to be united in one friendship and harmony, like relatives and
+friends, without separation. Having thus mingled together the bones of
+their mutual relatives and friends, they pronounce many discourses on the
+occasion. Then, after various grimaces or exhibitions, they make a great
+trench, ten fathoms square, in which they put the bones, together with the
+necklaces, chains of porcelain, axes, kettles, sword-blades, knives, and
+various other trifles, which, however, are of no slight account in their
+estimation. They cover the whole with earth, putting on top several great
+pieces of wood, and placing around many posts, on which they put a
+covering. This is their manner of proceeding with regard to the dead, and
+it is the most prominent ceremony they have. Some of them believe in the
+immortality of the soul, while others have only a presentiment of it,
+which, however, is not so very different; for they say that after their
+decease they will go to a place where they will sing, like crows, a song,
+it must be confessed, quite different from that of angels. On the following
+page are represented their sepulchres and manner of interment.
+
+It remains to describe how they spend their time in winter; namely, from
+the month of December to the end of March, or the beginning of our spring,
+when the snow melts. All that they might do during autumn, as I have before
+stated, they postpone to be done during winter; namely, their banquetings,
+and usual dances for the sake of the sick, which I have already described,
+and the assemblages of the inhabitants of various villages, where there are
+banquetings, singing, and dances, which they call _tabagies_ [197] and
+where sometimes five hundred persons are collected, both men, women, and
+girls. The latter are finely decked and adorned with the best and most
+costly things they have.
+
+On certain days they make masquerades, and visit each other's cabins,
+asking for the things they like, and if they meet those who have what they
+want, these give it to them freely. Thus they go on asking for many things
+without end; so that a single one of those soliciting will have robes of
+beaver, bear, deer, lynxes, and other furs, also fish, Indian corn,
+tobacco, or boilers, kettles, pots, axes, pruning-knives, knives, and other
+like things. They go to the houses and cabins of the village, singing these
+words, That one gave me this, another gave that, or like words, by way of
+commendation. But if one gives them nothing they get angry, and show such
+spite towards him that when they leave they take a stone and put it near
+this man or that woman who has not given them anything. Then, without
+saying a word, they return singing, which is a mark of insult, censure, and
+ill-will. The women do so as well as the men, and this mode of proceeding
+takes place at night, and the masquerade continues seven or eight days.
+There are some of their villages which have maskers or merry-makers, as we
+do on the evening of _Mardi-gras_, and they invite the other villages to
+come and see them and win their utensils, if they can. Meanwhile banquets
+are not wanting. This is the way they spend their time in winter.
+
+Moreover the women spin, and pound meal for the journeys of their husbands
+in summer, who go to other tribes to trade, as they decide to do at the
+above-mentioned councils, in which it is determined what number of men may
+go from each village, that it may not be deprived of men of war for its
+protection; and nobody goes from the country without the general consent of
+the chiefs, or if they should go they would be regarded as behaving
+improperly. The men make nets for fishing, which they carry on in summer,
+but generally in winter, when they capture the fish under the ice with the
+line or with the seine.
+
+The following is their manner of fishing. They make several holes in a
+circular form in the ice, the one where they are to draw the seine being
+some five feet long and three wide. Then they proceed to place their net at
+this opening, attaching it to a rod of wood from six to seven feet long,
+which they put under the ice. This rod they cause to pass from hole to
+hole, when one or more men, putting their hands in the holes, take hold of
+the rod to which is attached an end of the net, until they unite at the
+opening of five to six feet. Then they let the net drop to the bottom of
+the water, it being sunk by little stones attached to the end. After it is
+down they draw it up again with their arms at its two ends, thus capturing
+the fish that are in it. This is, in brief, their manner of fishing in
+winter.
+
+The winter begins in the month of November and continues until the month of
+April, when the trees begin to send forth the sap and show their buds.
+
+On the 22d of the month of April we received news from our interpreter, who
+had gone to Carantouean, through those who had come from there. They told us
+that they had left him on the road, he having returned to the village for
+certain reasons.
+
+Now, resuming the thread of my narrative, our savages assembled to come
+with us, and conduct us back to our habitation, and for this purpose we set
+out from their country on the 20th of the month, [198] and were forty days
+on the way. We caught a large number of fish and animals of various kinds,
+together with small game, which afforded us especial pleasure, in addition
+to the provisions thus furnished us for our journey. Upon our arrival among
+the French, towards the end of the month of June, I found Sieur du Pont
+Grave, who had come from France with two vessels, and who had almost
+despaired of seeing me again, having heard from the savages the bad news,
+that I was dead.
+
+We also saw all the holy fathers who had remained at our settlement. They
+too were very happy to see us again, and we none the less so to see them.
+Welcomes, and felicitations on all sides being over, I made arrangements to
+set out from, the Falls of St. Louis for our settlement, taking with me my
+host D'Arontal. I took leave also of all the other savages, assuring them
+of my affection, and that, if I could, I would see them in the suture, to
+assist them as I had already done in the past, bringing them valuable
+presents to secure their friendship with one another, and begging them to
+forget all the disputes which they had had when I reconciled them, which
+they promised to do.
+
+Then we set out, on the 8th of July, and arrived at our settlement on the
+11th of that month. Here I found everybody in good health, and we all, in
+company with our holy fathers, who chanted the Divine service, returned
+thanks to God for His care in preserving us, and protecting us amid the
+many perils and dangers to which we had been exposed.
+
+After this, and when everything had become settled, I proceeded to show
+hospitalities to my host, D'Arontal, who admired our building, our conduct,
+and mode of living. After carefully observing us, he said to me, in
+private, that he should never die contented until he had seen all of his
+friends, or at least a good part of them, come and take up their abode with
+us, in order to learn how to serve God, and our way of living, which he
+esteemed supremely happy in comparison with their own. Moreover he said
+that, if he could not learn it by word of mouth, he would do so much better
+and more easily by sight and by frequent intercourse, and that, if their
+minds could not comprehend our arts, sciences, and trades, their children
+who were young could do so, as they had often represented to us in their
+country in conversation with Father Joseph. He urged us, for the promotion
+of this object, to make another settlement at the Falls of St. Louis, so as
+to secure them the passage of the river against their enemies, assuring us
+that, as soon as we should build a house, they would come in numbers to
+live as brothers with us. Accordingly I promised to make a settlement for
+them as soon as possible.
+
+After we had remained four or five days together, I gave him some valuable
+presents, with which he was greatly pleased, and I begged him to continue
+his affection for us, and come again to see our settlement with his
+friends. Then he returned happy to the Falls of St Louis, where his
+companions awaited him.
+
+When this Captain D'Arontal had departed, we enlarged our habitation by a
+third at least in buildings and fortifications, since it was not
+sufficiently spacious, nor convenient for receiving the members of our own
+company and likewise the strangers that might come to see us. We used, in
+building, lime and sand entirely, which we found very good there in a spot
+near the habitation. This is a very useful material for building for those
+disposed to adapt and accustom themselves to it.
+
+The Fathers Denis and Joseph determined to return to France, in order to
+testify there to all they had seen, and to the hope they could promise
+themselves of the conversion of these people, who awaited only the
+assistance of the holy fathers in order to be converted and brought to our
+faith and the Catholic religion.
+
+During my stay at the settlement I had some common grain cut; namely,
+French grain, which had been planted there and which had come up very
+finely, that I might take it to France, as evidence that the land is good
+and fertile. In another part, moreover, there was some fine Indian corn,
+also scions and trees which had been given us by Sieur du Monts in
+Normandy. In a word all the gardens of the place were in an admirably fine
+condition, being planted with peas, beans, and other vegetables, also
+squashes, and very superior radishes of various sorts, cabbages, beets, and
+other kitchen vegetables. When on the point of departure, we left two of
+our fathers at the settlement; namely, Fathers Jean d'Olbeau and Pacifique,
+[199] who were greatly pleased with all the time spent at that place, and
+resolved to await there the return of Father Joseph, [200] who was expected
+to come back in the following year, which he did.
+
+We sailed in our barques the 20th day of July, and arrived at Tadoussac the
+23d day of the month, where Sieur du Pont Grave awaited us with his vessel
+ready and equipped. In this we embarked and set out the 3d day of the month
+of August. The wind was so favorable that we arrived in health by the grace
+of God, at Honfleur, on the 10th day of September, one thousand six hundred
+and sixteen, and upon our arrival rendered praise and thanks to God for his
+great care in preserving our lives, and delivering and even snatching us,
+as it were, from the many dangers to which we had been exposed, and for
+bringing and conducting us in health to our country; we besought Him also
+to move the heart of our King, and the gentlemen of his council, to
+contribute their assistance so far as necessary to bring these poor savages
+to the knowledge of God, whence honor will redound to his Majesty, grandeur
+and growth to his realm, profit to his subjects, and the glory of all these
+undertakings and toils to God, the sole author of all excellence, to whom
+be honor and glory. Amen.
+
+
+ENDNOTES:
+
+78. Champlain's first voyage was made in 1603, and this journal was
+ published in 1619. It was therefore fully fifteen years since his
+ explorations began.
+
+79. _Vide Histoire du Canada_, par Sagard, Trois ed., pp 27, 28. The reader
+ is likewise referred to the Memoir of Champlain, Vol. I. pp 122-124.
+
+80. Bernard du Verger, a man of exalted virtue--_Laverdiere_.
+
+81. Robert Ubaldim was nuncio at this time. _Vide Laverdiere in loco_.
+
+82. Denis Jamay. Sagard writes this name _Jamet_.
+
+83. Jean d'Olbeau. _Vide Histoire du Canada_, par Gabriel Sagard, Paris,
+ 1636, Tross ed., Vol. I. p. 28.
+
+84. Pacifique du Plessis was a lay-brother, although the title of Father is
+ given to him by several early writers. _Vide citations by Laverdiere in
+ loco_, Quebec ed., Vol. IV. p. 7.
+
+85. Read April 24. It is obvious from the context that it could not be
+ August. Sagard says _le_ 24 _d'Auril_. _Vide Histoire du Canada_, Trois
+ ed., Vol. I. p 36.
+
+86. The Recollect Father Joseph le Caron.
+
+87. _Vide Laverdiere in loco_.
+
+88. Father Denis Jamay.
+
+89. Jean d'Olbeau and Pacifique du Plessis.
+
+90. This refers to the volume bearing date 1613, but which may not have
+ been actually issued from the press till 1614.
+
+91. Our views of the war policy of Champlain are stated at some length in
+ Vol I. pp 189-193.
+
+92. Laverdiere thinks it probable that Champlain left the Falls of St Louis
+ on the 23d of June, and that the Holy Mass was celebrated on the
+ Riviere des Prairies on the 24th, the festival of St John the Baptist.
+
+93. This interpreter was undoubtedly Etienne Brule. It was a clearly
+ defined policy of Champlain to send suitable young men among the
+ savages, particularly to learn their language, and subsequently to act
+ as interpreters. Brule is supposed to have been of this class.
+
+94. The Lake of Two Mountains.
+
+95. The River Ottawa, which Champlain had explored in 1613, as far as
+ Allumet Island, where a tribe of the Algonquins resided, called later
+ _Kichesipinni_. _Vide Relation des Jesuites_, 1640, p 34.
+
+96. This is an over-estimate.
+
+97. Champlain here again, _Vide_ note 90, refers to the issue bearing date
+ 1613. It is not unlikely that while it bears the imprint of 1613, it
+ did not actually issue from the press till 1614.
+
+98. The lake or expansion of the Ottawa on the southern side of Allumet
+ Island was called the lake of the Algonquins, as Allumet Island was
+ oftentimes called the Island of the Algonquins.
+
+99. The River Ottawa.
+
+100. Pere Vimont calls this tribe _Kotakoutouemi_. _Relation des Jesuites_,
+ 1640, p. 34. Pere Rogueneau gives _Outaoukotouemiouek_, and remarks
+ that their language is a mixture of Algonquin and Montagnais. _Vide
+ Relation des Jesuites_, 1650. p. 34; also _Laverdiere in loco_.
+
+101. _Blues_, blueberries. The Canada blueberry. _Vaccinium Canadense_.
+ Under the term _blues_ several varieties may have been included.
+ Charlevoix describes and figures this fruit under the name _Bluet du
+ Canada. _Vide Description des Plantes Principales de l'Amerique
+ Septentrionale_, in _Histoire de la Nouvelle France_, Paris. 1744,
+ Tom. IV. pp. 371, 372; also Vol. I: p 303, note 75, of this work.
+
+102. At its junction with the Mattawan, the Ottawa's course is from the
+ north. What is known as its east branch rises 150 miles north of the
+ city of Ottawa. Extending towards the west in a winding course for the
+ distance of about 300 miles, it turns towards the southeast, and a few
+ miles before it joins the Mattawan its course is directly south. From
+ its northeastern source by a short portage is reached the river
+ Chomouchouan, an affluent of Lake St. John and the Saguenay.
+
+103. Mattawa is 197 miles from Ottawa. We have no means of giving the
+ latitude with entire accuracy, but it is about 46 deg. 20'.
+
+104. Lac du Talon and Lac la Tortue.
+
+105. Nipissings, or Nipissirini. Champlain writes _Nipisierinii_.
+
+106. On the 26th of July, The distance from the junction of the Ottawa and
+ the Mattawan to Lake Nipissing is about thirty-two miles If _lieues_
+ were translated miles, it would be a not very incorrect estimate.
+
+107. _Vide_ the representations here referred to.
+
+108. Lake Nipissing, whose dimensions are over-stated.
+
+109. Sturgeon River.
+
+110. Pere Vimont gives the names of these tribes as follows,--_Timiscimi,
+ Outimagami, Ouachegami, Mitchitamou, Outurbi, Kiristinon_. _Vide
+ Relation des Jesuites_. 1640. p. 34.
+
+111. French River.
+
+112. _Blues_. _Vide antea_, note 101.
+
+113. This significant name is given with reference to their mode of
+ dressing their hair.
+
+114. Blueberries, _Vaccinium Canadense_.
+
+115. _De cuir beullu_, for _cuir bouilli_, literally "boiled leather."
+
+116. The shields of the savages of this region may have been made of the
+ hide of the buffalo, although the range of this animal was far to the
+ northwest of them. Champlain saw undoubtedly among the Hurons skins of
+ the buffalo. _Vide postea_, note 180.
+
+117. Lake Huron is here referred to.
+
+118. The greatest length of Lake Huron on a curvilinear line, between the
+ discharge of St Mary's Strait and the outlet, is about 240 miles; its
+ length due north and south is 186 miles, and its extreme breadth about
+ 220 miles. _Bouchette_.
+
+119. Coasting along the eastern shore of the Georgian Bay, when they
+ arrived at Matchedash Bay they crossed it in a southwesterly course
+ and entered the country of the Attigouautans, or, as they are
+ sometimes called, the Attignaouentans. _Relation des Jesuites,_ 1640,
+ p. 78. They were a principal tribe of the Hurons, living within the
+ limits of the present county of Simcoe. It is to be regretted that the
+ Jesuit Fathers did not accompany their relations with local maps by
+ which we could fix, at least approximately, the Indian towns which
+ they visited, and with which they were so familiar. For a description
+ of the Hurons and of their country, the origin of the name and other
+ interesting particulars, _vide Pere Hierosine Lalemant, Relation des
+ Jesuites_, 1639, Quebec ed. p. 50.
+
+120. _Sitrouilles_ for _citrouilles_. _Vide_ Vol II. p. 64, note 128.
+
+121. _Herbe au soleil_. The sunflower of Northeast America, _Helianthus
+ multiflorus_. This species is found from Quebec to the Saskatchewan, a
+ tributary of Lake Winnipeg. _Vide Chronological History of Plants_, by
+ Charles Pickering, M.D., Boston, 1879. p. 914. Charlevoix, in the
+ description of his journey through Canada in 1720, says: "The Soleil
+ is a plant very common in the fields of the savages, and which grows
+ seven or eight feet high. Its flower, which is very large, is in the
+ shape of the marigold, and the seed grows in the same manner. The
+ savages, by boiling it, draw out an oil, with which they grease their
+ hair." _Letters to the Dutchess of Lesdiguieres_, London, 1763, p. 95.
+
+122. _Vignes_ Probably the frost grape, _Vitis cordifolia_.
+
+123. _Prunes_. The Canada plum, _Prunus Americana_.
+
+124. _Framboises_. The wild red raspberry, _Rubus strigosus_.
+
+125. _Fraises_. The wild strawberry, _Fragaria Virginiana_. _Vide
+ Pickering Chro. Hist. Plants_, p. 771.
+
+126. _Petites pommes sauuages_. Probably the American crab-apple, _Pyrus
+ coronaria_.
+
+127. _Noix_ This may include the butternut and some varieties of the
+ walnut. _Vide_ Vol. I. p. 264.
+
+128. Doubtless the May-apple, _Podophyllum peltatum_. In the wilds of
+ Simcoe this fruit may have seemed tolerable from the absence of others
+ more desirable. Gray says, "It is slightly acid, mawkish, eaten by
+ pigs and boys." _Cf. Florula Bostioniensis_, by Jacob Bigelow,
+ M.D. Boston, 1824, pp. 215, 216.
+
+129. _Les Chesnes, ormeaux, & heslres_. For oaks see Vol I. p. 264. Elms,
+ plainly the white elm, _Ulmus Americana_, so called in
+ contradistinction to the red or slippery elm, _Ulmus fulva_. The
+ savages sometimes used the bark of the slippery elm in the
+ construction of their canoes when the white birch could not be
+ obtained. _Vide Charlevoix's Letters_, 1763, p. 94. For the beech, see
+ Vol. I. p. 264.
+
+130. _Perdrix_. Canada Grouse, _Tetrao Canadensis_, sometimes called the
+ Spruce Partridge, differing from the partridge of New England, which
+ is the Ruffed Grouse, _Bonasa umbellus_. This latter species is,
+ however, found likewise in Canada.
+
+131. _Lapins_. The American hare, _Lepus Americanus_.
+
+132. _Cerises petites_. Reference is evidently here made to the wild red
+ cherry, _Prunus Pennsylvanica_, which is the smallest of all the
+ native species. _Cf_. Vol. I. p. 264.
+
+133. _Merises_. The wild black cherry, _Prunus serotina_.
+
+134. The Carantouanais. _Vide Carte de la Nouvelle France_, 1632, _also_
+ Vol. I. p. 304. This tribe was probably situated on the upper waters
+ of the Susquehanna, and consequently south of the Five Nations,
+ although we said inadvertently in Vol. I. p. 128 that they were on the
+ west of them. General John S. Clark thinks their village was at
+ Waverly, near the border of Pennsylvania In Vol. I. p. 143. in the
+ 13th line from the top, we should have said the Carantouanais instead
+ of _Entouhonorons_.
+
+135. The Entouhonorons were a part, it appears, of the Five Nations.
+ Champlain says they unite with the Iroquois in making war against all
+ the other tribes except the Neutral Nation. Lake Ontario is called
+ _Lac des Entouhonorons_, and Champlain adds that their country is near
+ the River St. Lawrence, the passage of which they forbid to all other
+ tribes. _Vide_ Vol. I. pp. 303, 304. He thus appears to apply the name
+ _Iroquois_ to the eastern portion of the Five Nations, particularly
+ those whom he had attacked on Lake Champlain; and the Huron name,
+ _Entouhonorons_, to the western portion. The subdivisions, by which
+ they were distinguished at a later period, were probably not then
+ known, at least not to Champlain.
+
+136. _Flamens_. The Dutch were at this time on the Hudson, qengaged in the
+ fur trade with the savages. _Vide History of the State of New York_ by
+ John Romeyn Brodhead, New York, 1853. pp. 38-65. _History of New
+ Netherland_ or _New York under the Dutch_, by E. B. O'Callaghan, New
+ York, 1846, pp. 67-77.
+
+137. Their enemies were the Iroquois.
+
+138. _Chouontouaroueon_, another name for _Entouhoronon_.
+
+139. Lake Couchiching, a small sheet of water into which pass by a small
+ outlet the waters of Lake Simcoe.
+
+140. Lake Simcoe. Laverdiere says the Indian name of this lake was
+ _Ouentaronk_, and that it was likewise called _Lac aux Claies_.
+
+141. Etienne Brule. _Vide postea_, p. 208.
+
+142. _Dans ces lacs_. From Lake Chouchiching, coasting along the
+ northeastern shore of Lake Simcoe, they would make five or six leagues
+ in reaching a point nearest to Sturgeon Lake.
+
+143. Undoubtedly Sturgeon Lake.
+
+144. From their entrance of Sturgeon Lake to the point where they reached
+ Lake Ontario, at the eastern limit of Amherst Island, the distance is,
+ in its winding and circuitous course, not far from Champlain's
+ estimate, viz. sixty-four leagues. That part of the river above Rice
+ Lake is the Otonabee; that below is known as the Trent.
+
+145. _Grues_ The white crane, _Grus Americanus_ Adult plumage pure white
+ _Coues's Key to North American Birds_, Boston, 1872, p 271 Charlevoix
+ says, "We have cranes of two colors, some white and others _gris de
+ lin_," that is a purple or lilac color. This latter species is the
+ brown crane, _Grus Canadensis_. "Plumage plumbeous gray." _Coues_.
+ _Vide Charlevoix's Letters_, London. 1763, p 83.
+
+146. The latitude of the eastern end of Amherst Island is about 44 deg. 11'.
+
+147. This traverse, it may be presumed, was made by coasting along the
+ shore, as was the custom of the savages with their light canoes.
+
+148. It appears that, after making by estimate about fourteen leagues in
+ their bark canoes, and four by land along the shore, they struck
+ inland. Guided merely by the distances given in the text, it is not
+ possible to determine with exactness at what point they left the
+ lake. This arises from the fact that we are not sure at what point the
+ measurement began, and the estimated distances are given, moreover,
+ with very liberal margins. But the eighteen leagues in all would take
+ them not very far from Little Salmon River, whether the estimate were
+ made from the eastern end of Amherst Island or Simcoe Island, or any
+ place in that immediate neighborhood. The natural features of the
+ country, for four leagues along the coast north of Little Salmon
+ River, answer well to the description given in the text. The chestnut
+ and wild grape are still found there. _Vide MS. Letters of the
+ Rev. James Cross, D.D., LL.D., and of S.Z. Smith, Esq._, of Mexico,
+ New York.
+
+149. Lake Ontario, or Lake of the Entouhonorons, is about a hundred and
+ eighty miles long, and about fifty-five miles in its extreme width.
+
+150. The river here crossed was plainly Oneida River, flowing from Oneida
+ Lake into Lake Ontario. The lake is identified by the islands in it.
+ Oneida Lake is the only one in this region which contains any islands
+ whatever, and consequently the river flowing from it must be that now
+ known as Oneida River.
+
+151. For the probable site of this fort, see Vol. I. p. 130, note 83.
+
+152. They were of the tribe called Carantouanais. _Vide antea_, note 134.
+
+153. This was in the month of October.
+
+154. _Et apres auoir trauerse le bout du lac de laditte isle_. From this
+ form of expression this island would seem to have been visited before.
+ But no particular island is mentioned on their former traverse of the
+ lake. It is impossible to fix with certainty upon the isiand referred
+ to. It may have been Simcoe or Wolf Island, or some other.
+
+155. Probably Cataraqui Creek. _Vide_ Vol. I. p. 136.
+
+156. Perhaps Loughborough Lake, or the system of lakes of which this is a
+ part.
+
+157. _Cygnes_, swans. Probably the Trumpeter Swan, _Cygnus buccinator_.
+ They were especially found in Sagard's time about Lake Nipissing.
+ "Mais pour des Cignes, qu'ils appellent _Horhev_, il y en a
+ principalement vers les Epicerinys." _Vide Le Grand Voyage av Pays des
+ Hurons_ par Fr. Gabriel Sagard, Paris, 1632, p. 303.
+
+158. _Grues blanches_. _Vide antea_, n. 145.
+
+159. _Houstardes_. _Vide antea_, note 32.
+
+160. _Mauuis_, Song-Thrush. Doubtless the Robin, _Turdus migratorius_.
+
+161. _Allouettes_, larks. Probably the Brown Lark, _Anthus ludovicianus_.
+ Found everywhere in North America.
+
+162. _Beccassines_. Probably the American Snipe, _Gallinago Wilsonii_.
+
+163. _Oyes_, geese. The common Wild Goose, _Branta Canadensis_, or it may
+ include all the species taken collectively. For the several species
+ found in Canada, _vide antea_, note 32.
+
+164. _Les loups_. The American Wolf, _Lupus occidentalis_.
+
+165. The thirty-eight days during which they were there would include the
+ whole period from the time they began to make their preparations on
+ the 28th of October on the shores of Lake Ontario till they began
+ their homeward journey on the 4th of December. _Vide antea_, p. 137;
+ _postea_, p. 143.
+
+166. The author here refers to the chief D'Arontal, whose guest he
+ was. _Vide antea_, 137. Cf. also Quebec ed. 1632, p. 928.
+
+167. _Trainees de bois_, a kind of sledge. The Indian's sledge was made of
+ two pieces of board, which, with his stone axe and perhaps with the
+ aid of fire, he patiently manufactured from the trunks of trees. The
+ boards were each about six inches wide and six or seven feet long,
+ curved upward at the forward end and bound together by cross pieces.
+ The sides were bordered with strips of wood, which served as brackets,
+ to which was fastened the strap that bound the baggage upon the
+ sledge. The load was dragged by a rope or strap of leather passing
+ round the breast of the savage and attached to the end of the sledge.
+ The sledge was so narrow that it could be drawn easily and without
+ impediment wherever the savage could thread his way through the
+ pathless forests.
+
+ The journey from their encampment northeast of Kingston on Lake
+ Ontario to the capital of the Hurons was not less in a straight line
+ than a hundred and sixty miles. Without a pathway, in the heart of
+ winter, through water and melting snow, with their heavy burdens, the
+ hardship and exhaustion can hardly be exaggerated.
+
+168. Namely at Cahiague. In the issue of 1632, Champlain says they arrived
+ on the 23d day of the month. _Vide_ Quebec ed, p. 929. Leaving on the
+ 4th and travelling nineteen days, as stated above, they would arrive
+ on the 23d December.
+
+169. Probably the 4th of January.
+
+170. Father Joseph Le Caron had remained at Carhagouha, during the absence
+ of the war party in their attack upon the Iroquois, where Champlain
+ probably arrived on the 5th of January.
+
+171. In the issue of 1632, the arrival of Champlain and Le Caron is stated
+ to have occurred on the 17th of January. This harmonizes with the
+ correction of dates in notes 169, 170.
+
+ The Huron name of the Petuns was _Tionnontateronons_, or
+ _Khionontateronons_, or _Quieunontateronons_. Of them Vimont says,
+ "Les Khionontateronons, qu'on appelle la nation du Petun, pour
+ l'abondance qu'il y a de cette herbe, sont eloignez du pays des
+ Hurons, dont ils parlent la langue, enuiron douze ou quinze lieues
+ tirant a l'Occident." _Vide Relation des Jesuites_, 1640, p. 95;
+ _His. Du Canada_, Vol. I. p. 209. Sagard.
+
+ For some account of the subsequent history of the Nation de Petun,
+ _vide Indian Migration in Ohio_, by C. C. Baldwin, 1879, p. 2.
+
+172. It was of great importance to the Indians to select a site for their
+ villages where suitable wood was accessible, both for fortifying them
+ with palisades and for fuel in the winter. It could not be brought a
+ great distance for either of these purposes. Hence when the wood in
+ the vicinity became exhausted they were compelled to remove and build
+ anew.
+
+173. That is to say like the Hurons.
+
+174. The Nation Neutre was called by the Hurons _Attisandaronk_ or
+ _Attihouandaron_. _Vide Relation des Jesuites_, 1641, p. 72;
+ _Dictonaire de la Langue Huronne_, par Sagard, a Paris, 1632.
+ Champlain places them, on his map of 1632, south of Lake Erie. His
+ knowledge of that lake, obtained from the savages, was very meagre as
+ the map itself shows. The Neutres are placed by early writers on the
+ west of Lake Ontario and north of Lake Erie _Vide Laverdiere in loco_,
+ Quebec ed., p. 546; also, _Indian Migration in Ohio_, by C. C.
+ Baldwin, p. 4. They are placed far to the south of Lake Erie by
+ Nicholas Sanson. _Vide Cartes de l'Amerique_, 1657.
+
+175. The Cheveux Releves are represented by Champlain as dwelling west of
+ the Petuns, and were probably not far from the most southern limit of
+ the Georgian Bay. Strangely enough Nicholas Sanson places them on a
+ large island that separates the Georgian Bay from Lake Huron. _Vide
+ Cartes de l'Amerique_ par N. Sanson, 1657.
+
+176. _Atsistaehronons, ou Nation du Feu_. Their Algonquin name was
+ Mascoutins or Maskoutens. with several other orthographies. The
+ significance of their name is given by Sagard as follows: Ils sont
+ errans, sinon que quelques villages d'entr'eux fement des bleds
+ d'Inde, et font la guerre a vne autre Nation, nommee _Assitagueronon_,
+ qui veut dire gens de feu: car en langue Huronne _Assista_ signifie du
+ feu, et _Eronon_, signifie Nation. _Le Grand Voyage du Pays des
+ Hurons_, par Gabriel Sagard, a Paris, 1632, p. 78. _Vide Relation des
+ Jesuites_, 1641, p 72; _Discovery and Exploration of the Mississippi
+ Valley_, by John Gilmary Shea, p. 13; _Indian Migration in Ohio_, by
+ C. C. Baldwin, pp 9, 10; Discovery of the _Northwest by John Nicolet_,
+ by C. W. Butterfield, p. 63; _L'Amerique en Plusieurs Cartes_, par
+ N. Sanson, 1657.
+
+177. _Pisierinii_, the Nipissings. This relates to those Nipissings who had
+ accompanied Champlain on the expedition against the Iroquois, and who
+ were passing the winter among the Hurons. He had expected that they
+ would accompany him on explorations on the north of them. But arriving
+ at their encampment, on his return from the Petuns and Cheveux
+ Releves, he learned from them of the quarrel that had arisen between
+ the Algonquins and the Hurons.
+
+178. Attigouantans, the principal tribe of the Hurons.
+
+179. _Colliers de pourceline_. These necklaces were composed of shells,
+ pierced and strung like beads. They were of a violet color, and were
+ esteemed of great value. The _branches_ were strings of white shells,
+ and were more common and less valuable. An engraved representation may
+ be seen in _Histoire de L'Amerique Septentrionale_, par De la
+ Potherie, Paris, 1722, Tom. I. p. 334. For a full description of
+ these necklaces and their significance and use in their councils,
+ _vide Charlevoix's Letters_, London, 1763, p 132.
+
+180. _Buffles_, buffaloes. The American Bison, _Bos Americanus_. The skins
+ seen by Champlain in the possession of the savages seem to indicate
+ that the range of the buffalo was probably further east at that period
+ than at the present time, its eastern limit being now about the Red
+ River, which flows into Lake Winnipeg. The limit of its northern range
+ is generally stated to be at latitude 60 degrees, but it is sometimes
+ found as far north as 63 degrees or 64 degrees. _Vide_ Dr. Shea's
+ interesting account of the buffalo in _Discovery and Exploration of
+ Mississippi Valley_, p. 18. The range of the Musk Ox is still farther
+ north, rarely south of latitude 67 degrees. His home is in the Barren
+ Grounds, west of Hudson Bay, and on the islands on the north of the
+ American Continent, where he subsists largely on lichens and the
+ meagre herbage of that frosty region.
+
+181. Champlain is here speaking of the whole country of New France.
+
+182. This sentence in the original is unfinished and defective. _Au coste
+ vers le Nort, icelle grande riuiere terant a l'Occident, etc_. In the
+ ed. 1632, the reading is _Au coste vers le nort d'icelle grande
+ riuiere tirant au suroust, etc_. The tranlation is according to the
+ ed. of 1632. _Vide_ Quebec ed., p. 941.
+
+183. Champlain here gives the four species of the _cervus_ family under
+ names then known to him, viz, the moose, wapiti or elk, caribou, and
+ the common deer.
+
+184. _Fouines_, a quadruped known as the minx or mink, _Mustela vison_.
+
+185. _Martes_, weasels, _Mustela vulgaris_.
+
+186. _The country on the north_, &c. Having described the country along the
+ coast of the St Lawrence and the lakes he now refers to the country
+ still further north even to the southern borders of Hudson's Bay
+ _Vide_ small map.
+
+187. _Almouchiquois_, so in the French for Almouchiquois. All the tribes at
+ and south of _Chouacoet_, or the mouth of the Saco River, were
+ denominated Almouchiquois by the French. _Vide_ Vol II p 63, _et
+ passim_.
+
+188. The country of the Attigouantans, sometimes written Attigouautans, the
+ principal tribe of the Hurons, used by Champlain as including the
+ whole, with whom the French were in close alliance, was from east to
+ west not more than about twelve leagues. There must have been some
+ error by which the author is made to say that it was _two hundred and
+ thirty leagues_. Laverdiere suggests that in the manuscript it might
+ have been 23, or 20 to 30, and that the printer made it 230.
+
+189. The author plainly means that the country of the Hurons was nearly
+ surrounded by the Mer Douce; that is to say, by Lake Huron and the
+ waters connected with it, viz., the River Severn, Lake Couchiching,
+ and Lake Simcoe. As to the population, compare _The Jesuits in North
+ America_, by Francis Parkman, LL.D., note p. xxv.
+
+190. _Vide antea_, note 172, for the reason of these removals.
+
+191. _Febues du Bresil_. This was undoubtedly the common trailing bean,
+ _Pliaseolus vulgaris_, probably called the Brazilian bean, because it
+ resembled a bean known under that name. It was found in cultivation in
+ New England as mentioned by Champlain and the early English settlers.
+ Bradford discoursing of the Indians, _His. Plymouth Plantation_,
+ p. 83, speaks of "their beans of various collours." It is possible
+ that the name, _febues du Bresil_, was given to it on account of its
+ red color, as was that of the Brazil-wood, from the Portuguese word
+ _braza_, a burning coal.
+
+192. _Vide antea_, note 101.
+
+193. _Sitrouelles_, or _citrouilles_, the common summer squash, _Cucurbita
+ polymorpha. Vide_ Vol. II. note 128. For figure D, _vide_ p. 116.
+
+194. The coloring matter appears to have been derived from the root of the
+ bedstraw, _Galium tinctorum_. Peter Kalm, a pupil of Linnaeus, who
+ travelled in Canada in 1749, says, "The roots of this plant are
+ employed by the Indians in dyeing the quills of the American
+ porcupines red, which they put into several pieces of their work, and
+ air, sun, or water seldom change this color." _Travels into North
+ America_, London, 1771, Vol. III. pp. 14-15.
+
+195. Pere Joseph Le Caron, who had passed the winter among the Hurons.
+
+196. _Mardi-gras_, Shrove-Tuesday, or _flesh Tuesday_, the last day of the
+ Carnival, the day before Ash Wednesday, the first day in Lent.
+
+197. _Vide_ Vol. I. pp. 236-238.
+
+198. This must have been on the 20th of May.
+
+199. Jean d'Olbeau and the lay brother Pacifique du Plessis.
+
+200. Joseph le Caron, who accompanied Champlain to France.
+
+
+
+
+CONTINUATION OF THE VOYAGES
+AND DISCOVERIES MADE IN NEW FRANCE,
+BY
+SIEUR DE CHAMPLAIN,
+CAPTAIN FOR THE KING IN THE WESTERN MARINE,
+IN THE YEAR 1618.
+
+
+At the beginning of the year one thousand six hundred and eighteen, on the
+twenty-second of March, I set out from Paris, [201] together with my
+brother-in-law, [202] for Honfleur, our usual port of embarkation. There we
+were obliged to make a long stay on account of contrary winds. But when
+they had become favorable, we embarked on the large vessel of the
+association, which Sieur du Pont Grave commanded. There was also on board a
+nobleman, named De la Mothe, [203] who had previously made a voyage with
+the Jesuits to the regions of La Cadie, where he was taken prisoner by the
+English, and by them carried to the Virginias, the place of their
+settlement. Some time after they transferred him to England and from there
+to France, where there arose in him an increased desire to make another
+voyage to New France, which led him to seek the opportunity presented by
+me. I had assured him, accordingly, that I would use my influence and
+assistance with our associates, as it seemed to me that they would find
+such a person desirable, since he would be very useful in those regions.
+
+Our embarkation being made, we took our departure from Honfleur on the 24th
+day of May following, in the year 1618. The wind was favorable for our
+voyage, but continued so only a very few days, when it suddenly changed,
+and we had all the time head winds up to our arrival, on the 3d day of June
+following, on the Grand Bank, where the fresh fishery is carried on. Here
+we perceived to the windward of us some banks of ice, which came down from
+the north. While waiting for a favorable wind we engaged in fishing, which
+afforded us great pleasure, not only on account of the fish but also of a
+kind of bird called _fauquets_, [204] and other kinds that are caught on
+the line like fish. For, on throwing the line, with its hook baited with
+cod liver, these birds made for it with a rush, and in such numbers that
+you could not draw it out in order to throw it again, without capturing
+them by the beak, feet, and wings as they slew and fell upon the bait, so
+great were the eagerness and voracity of these birds. This fishing afforded
+us great pleasure, not only on account of the sport, but on account of the
+infinite number of birds and fish that we captured, which were very good
+eating, and made a very desirable change on shipboard.
+
+Continuing on our route, we arrived on the 15th of the month off Isle
+Percee, and on St. John's day [205] following entered the harbor of
+Tadoussac, where we found our small vessel, which had arrived three weeks
+before us. The men on her told us that Sieur des Chesnes, the commander,
+had gone to our settlement at Quebec. Thence he was to go to the Trois
+Rivieres to meet the savages, who were to come there from various regions
+for the purpose of trade, and likewise to determine what was to be done on
+account of the death of two of our men, who had been treacherously and
+perfidiously killed by two vicious young men of the Montagnais. These two
+unfortunate victims, as the men on the vessel informed us, had been killed
+while out hunting nearly two years [206] before. Those in the settlement
+had always supposed that they had been drowned from the upsetting of their
+canoe, until a short time before, one of the men, conceiving an animosity
+against the murderers, made a disclosure and communicated the fact and
+cause of the murder to the men of our settlement. For certain reasons it
+has seemed to me well to give an account of the matter and of what was done
+in regard to it. But it is almost impossible to obtain the exact truth in
+the case, on account, not only of the small amount of testimony at hand,
+but of the diversity of the statements made, the most of which were
+presumptive. I will, however, give an account of the matter here, following
+the statement of the greater number as being nearer the truth, and relating
+what I have found to be the most probable.
+
+The following is the occasion of the murder of the two unfortunate
+deceased. One of the two murderers paid frequent visits to our settlement,
+receiving there a thousand kindnesses and favors, among other persons from
+Sieur du Parc, a nobleman from Normandy, in command at the time at Quebec,
+in the service of the King and in behalf of the merchants of the
+Association in the year 1616. This savage, while on one of his customary
+visits, received one day, on account of some jealousy, ill treatment from
+one of the two murdered men, who was by profession a locksmith, and who
+after some words beat the savage so soundly as to impress it well upon his
+memory. And not satisfied with beating and misusing the savage he incited
+his companions to do the same, which aroused still more the hatred and
+animosity of the savage towards this locksmith and his companions, and led
+him to seek an opportunity to revenge himself. He accordingly watched for a
+time and opportunity for doing so, acting however cautiously and appearing
+as usual, without showing any sign of resentment.
+
+Some time after, the locksmith and a sailor named Charles Pillet, from the
+island of Re, arranged to go hunting and stay away three or four nights.
+For this purpose they got ready a canoe, and embarking departed from Quebec
+for Cape Tourmente. Here there were some little islands where a great
+quantity of game and birds resorted, near Isle d'Orleans, and distant seven
+leagues from Quebec. The departure of our men became at once known to the
+two savages, who were not slow in starting to pursue them and carry out
+their evil design. They sought for the place where the locksmith and his
+companion went to sleep, in order to surprise them. Having ascertained it
+at evening, at break of day on the following morning, the two savages
+slipped quietly along certain very pleasant meadows. Arriving at a point
+near the place in question, they moored their canoe, landed and went
+straight to the cabin, where our men had slept. But they found only the
+locksmith, who was preparing to go hunting with his companion, and who
+thought of nothing less than of what was to befall him. One of these
+savages approached him, and with some pleasant words removed from him all
+suspicion of anything wrong in order that he might the better deceive
+him. But as he saw him stoop to adjust his arquebus, he quickly drew a club
+that he had concealed on his person, and gave the locksmith so heavy a blow
+on his head, that it sent him staggering and completely stunned. The
+savage, seeing that the locksmith was preparing to defend himself, repeated
+his blow, struck him to the ground, threw himself upon him, and with a
+knife gave him three or four cuts in the stomach, killing him in this
+horrible manner.
+
+In order that they might also get possession of the sailor, the companion
+of the locksmith who had started early in the morning to go hunting, not
+because they bore any special hatred towards him, but that they might not
+be discovered nor accused by him, they went in all directions searching for
+him. At last, from the report of an arquebus which they heard, they
+discovered where he was, in which direction they rapidly hastened, so as to
+give no time to the sailor to reload his arquebus and put himself in a
+state of defence. Approaching, they fired their arrows at him, by which
+having prostrated him, they ran upon him and finished him with the knife.
+
+Then the assassins carried off the body, together with the other, and,
+binding them so firmly together that they would not come apart, attached to
+them a quantity of stones and pebbles, together with their weapons and
+clothes, so as not to be discovered by any sign, after which they carried
+them to the middle of the river, threw them in, and they sank to the
+bottom. Here they remained a long time until, through the will of God, the
+cords broke, and the bodies were washed ashore and thrown far up on the
+bank, to serve as accusers and incontestable witnesses of the attack of
+these two cruel and treacherous assassins. For the two bodies were found at
+a distance of more than twenty feet from the water in the woods, but had
+not become separated in so long a time, being still firmly bound, the
+bones, stripped of the flesh like a skeleton, alone remaining. For the two
+victims, contrary to the expectation of the two murderers, who thought they
+had done their work so secretly that it would never be known, were found a
+long time after their disappearance by the men of our settlement, who,
+pained at their absence, searched for them along the banks of the river.
+But God in his justice would not permit so enormous a crime, and had caused
+it to be exposed by another savage, their companion, in retaliation for an
+injury he had received from them. Thus their wicked acts were disclosed.
+
+The holy Fathers and the men of the settlement were greatly surprised at
+seeing the bodies of these two unfortunates, with their bones all bare, and
+their skulls broken by the blows received from the club of the savages. The
+Fathers and others at the settlement advised to preserve them in some
+portion of the settlement until the return of our vessels, in order to
+consult with all the French as to the best course to pursue in the matter.
+Meanwhile our people at the settlement resolved to be on their guard, and
+no longer allow so much freedom to these savages as they had been
+accustomed to, but on the contrary require reparation for so cruel a murder
+by a process of justice, or some other way, or let things in the mean time
+remain as they were, in order the better to await our vessels and our
+return, that we might all together consult what was to be done in the
+matter.
+
+But the savages seeing that this iniquity was discovered, and that they and
+the murderer were obnoxious to the French, were seized with despair, and,
+fearing that our men would exercise vengeance upon them for this murder,
+withdrew for a while from our settlement.[207] Not only those guilty of the
+act but the others also being seized with fear came no longer to the
+settlement, as they had been accustomed to do, but waited for greater
+security for themselves.
+
+Finding themselves deprived of intercourse with us, and of their usual
+welcome, the savages sent one of their companions named by the French, _La
+Ferriere_, to make their excuses for this murder; namely, they asserted
+they had never been accomplices in it, and had never consented to it, and
+that, if it was desired to have the two murderers for the sake of
+inflicting justice, the other savages would willingly consent to it, unless
+the French should be pleased to take as reparation and restitution for the
+dead some valuable presents of skins, as they are accustomed to do in
+return for a thing that cannot be restored. They earnestly entreated the
+French to accept this rather than require the death of the accused which
+they anticipated would be hard for them to execute, and so doing to forget
+everything as if it had not occurred.
+
+To this, in accordance with the advice of the holy Fathers, it was decided
+to reply that the savages should bring and deliver up the two malefactors,
+in order to ascertain from them their accomplices, and who had incited them
+to do the deed. This they communicated to La Ferriere for him to report to
+his companions.
+
+This decision having been made, La Ferriere withdrew to his companions, who
+upon hearing the decision of the French found this procedure and mode of
+justice very strange and difficult; since they have no established law
+among themselves, but only vengeance and restitution by presents. After
+considering the whole matter and deliberating with one another upon it,
+they summoned the two murderers and set forth to them the unhappy position
+into which they had been thrown by the event of this murder, which might
+cause a perpetual war with the French, from which their women and children
+would suffer. However much trouble they might give us, and although they
+might keep us shut up in our settlement and prevent us from hunting,
+cultivating and tilling the soil, and although we were in too small numbers
+to keep the river blockaded, as they persuaded themselves to believe in
+their consultations; still, after all their deliberations, they concluded
+that it was better to live in peace with the French than in war and
+perpetual distrust.
+
+Accordingly the savages thus assembled, after finishing their consultation
+and representing the situation to the accused, asked them if they would not
+have the courage to go with them to the settlement of the French and appear
+before them; promising them that they should receive no harm, and assuring
+them that the French were lenient and disposed to pardon, and would in
+short go so far in dealing with them as to overlook their offence on
+condition of their not returning to such evil ways.
+
+The two criminals, finding themselves convicted in conscience, yielded to
+this proposition and agreed to follow this advice. Accordingly one of them
+made preparations, arraying himself in such garments and decorations as he
+could procure, as if he had been invited to go to a marriage or some great
+festivity. Thus attired, he went to the settlement, accompanied by his
+father, some of the principal chiefs, and the captain of their company. As
+to the other murderer, he excused himself from this journey, [208]
+realizing his guilt of the heinous act and fearing punishment.
+
+When now they had entered the habitation, which was forthwith surrounded by
+a multitude of the savages of their company, the bridge [209] was drawn up,
+and all of the French put themselves on guard, arms in hand. They kept a
+strict watch, sentinels being posted at the necessary points, for fear of
+what the savages outside might do, since they suspected that it was
+intended actually to inflict punishment upon the guilty one, who had so
+freely offered himself to our mercy, and not upon him alone, but upon those
+also who had accompanied him inside, who likewise were not too sure of
+their persons, and who, seeing matters in this state, did not expect to get
+out with their lives. The whole matter was very well managed and carried
+out, so as to make them realize the magnitude of the crime and have fear
+for the future. Otherwise there would have been no security with them, and
+we should have been obliged to live with arms in hand and in perpetual
+distrust.
+
+After this, the savages suspecting lest something might happen contrary to
+what they hoped from us, the holy Fathers proceeded to make them an address
+on the subject of this crime. They set forth to them the friendship which
+the French had shown them for ten or twelve years back, when we began to
+know them, during which time we had continually lived in peace and intimacy
+with them, nay even with such freedom as could hardly be expressed. They
+added moreover that I had in person assisted them several times in war
+against their enemies, thereby exposing my life for their welfare; while we
+were not under any obligations to do so, being impelled only by friendship
+and good will towards them, and feeling pity at the miseries and
+persecutions which their enemies caused them to endure and suffer. This is
+why we were unable to believe, they said, that this murder had been
+committed without their consent, and especially since they had taken it
+upon themselves to favor those who committed it.
+
+Speaking to the father of the criminal, they represented to him the
+enormity of the deed committed by his son, saying that as reparation for it
+he deserved death, since by our law so wicked a deed did not go unpunished,
+and that whoever was found guilty and convicted of it deserved to be
+condemned to death as reparation for so heinous an act; but, as to the
+other inhabitants of the country, who were not guilty of the crime, they
+said no one wished them any harm or desired to visit upon them the
+consequences of it.
+
+All the savages, having clearly heard this, said, as their only excuse, but
+with all respect, that they had not consented to this act; that they knew
+very well that these two criminals ought to be put to death, unless we
+should be disposed to pardon them; that they were well aware of their
+wickedness, not before but after the commission of the deed; that they had
+been informed of the death of the two ill-fated men too late to prevent it.
+Moreover, they said that they had kept it secret, in order to preserve
+constantly an intimate relationship and confidence with us, and declared
+that they had administered to the evil-doers severe reprimands, and set
+forth the calamity which they had not only brought upon themselves, but
+upon all their tribe, relatives and friends; and they promised that such a
+calamity should never occur again and begged us to forget this offence, and
+not visit it with the consequences it deserved, but rather go back to the
+primary motive which induced the two savages to go there, and have regard
+for that. Furthermore they said that the culprit had come freely and
+delivered himself into our hands, not to be punished but to receive mercy
+from the French.
+
+But the father, turning to the friar, [210] said with tears, there is my
+son, who committed the supposed crime; he is worthless, but consider that
+he is a young, foolish, and inconsiderate person, who has committed this
+act through passion, impelled by vengeance rather than by premeditation: it
+is in your power to give him life or death; you can do with him what you
+please, since we are both in your hands.
+
+After this address, the culprit son, presenting himself with assurance,
+spoke these words. "Fear has not so seized my heart as to prevent my coming
+to receive death according to my desserts and your law, of which I
+acknowledge myself guilty." Then he stated to the company the cause of the
+murder, and the planning and execution of it, just as I have related and
+here set forth.
+
+After his recital he addressed himself to one of the agents and clerks of
+the merchants of our Association, named _Beauchaine_, begging him to put
+him to death without further formality.
+
+Then the holy Fathers spoke, and said to them, that the French were not
+accustomed to put their fellow-men to death so suddenly, and that it was
+necessary to have a consultation with all the men of the settlement, and
+bring forward this affair as the subject of consideration. This being a
+matter of great consequence, it was decided that it should be carefully
+conducted and that it was best to postpone it to a more favorable occasion,
+which would be better adapted to obtain the truth, the present time not
+being favorable for many reasons.
+
+In the first place, we were weak in numbers in comparison with the savages
+without and within our settlement, who, resentful and full of vengeance as
+they are, would have been capable of setting fire on all sides and creating
+disorder among us. In the second place, there would have been perpetual
+distrust and no security in our intercourse with them. In the third place,
+trade would have been injured, and the service of the King impeded.
+
+In view of these and other urgent considerations, it was decided that we
+ought to be contented with their putting themselves in our power and their
+willingness to give satisfaction submissively, the father of the criminal
+on the one hand presenting and offering him to the company, and he, for his
+part, offering to give up his own life as restitution for his offence, just
+as his father offered to produce him whenever he might be required.
+
+This it was thought necessary to regard as a sort of honorable amend, and a
+satisfaction to justice. And it was considered that if we thus pardoned the
+offence, not only would the criminal receive his life from us, but, also,
+his father and companions would feel under great obligations. It was
+thought proper, however, to say to them as an explanation of our action,
+that, in view of the fact of the criminal's public assurance that all the
+other savages were in no respect accomplices, or to blame for the act, and
+had had no knowledge of it before its accomplishment, and in view of the
+fact that he had freely offered himself to death, it had been decided to
+restore him to his father, who should remain under obligations to produce
+him at any time. On these terms and on condition that he should in future
+render service to the French, his life was spared, that he and all the
+savages might continue friends and helpers of the French.
+
+Thus it was decided to arrange the matter until the vessels should return
+from France, when, in accordance with the opinion of the captains and
+others, a definite and more authoritative settlement was to be concluded.
+In the mean time we promised them every favor and the preservation of their
+lives, saying to them, however, for our security, that they should leave
+some of their children as a kind of hostage, to which they very willingly
+acceded, and left at the settlement two in the hands of the holy Fathers,
+who proceeded to teach their letters, and in less than three months taught
+them the alphabet and how to make the letters.
+
+From this it may be seen that they are capable of instruction and are
+easily taught, as Father Joseph [211] can testify.
+
+The vessels having safely arrived, Sieur du Pont Grave, some others, and
+myself were informed how the affair had taken place, as has been narrated
+above, when we all decided that it was desirable to make the savages feel
+the enormity of this murder, but not to execute punishment upon them, for
+various good reasons hereafter to be mentioned.
+
+As soon as our vessels had entered the harbor of Tadoussac, even on the
+morning of the next day, [212] Sieur du Pont Grave and myself set sail
+again, on a small barque of ten or twelve tons' burden. So also Sieur de la
+Mothe, together with Father Jean d'Albeau, [213] a friar, and one of the
+clerks and agent of the merchants, named _Loquin_, embarked on a little
+shallop, and we set out together from Tadoussac. There remained on the
+vessel another friar, called Father _Modeste_ [214] together with the pilot
+and master, to take care of her. We arrived at Quebec, the place of our
+settlement, on the 27th of June following. Here we found Fathers Joseph,
+Paul, and Pacifique, the friars, [215] and Sieur Hebert [216] with his
+family, together with the other members of the settlement. They were all
+well, and delighted at our return in good health like themselves, through
+the mercy of God.
+
+The same day Sieur du Pont Grave determined to go to Trois Rivieres, where
+the merchants carried on their trading, and to take with him some
+merchandise, with the purpose of meeting Sieur des Chesnes, who was already
+there. He also took with him Loquin, as before mentioned. I stayed at our
+settlement some days, occupying myself with business relating to it; among
+other things in building a furnace for making an experiment with certain
+ashes, directions for which had been given me, and which are in truth of
+great value; but it requires labor, diligence, watchfulness and skill; and
+for the working of these ashes a sufficient number of men are needed who
+are acquainted with this art. This first experiment did not prove
+successful, and we postponed further trial to a more favorable opportunity.
+
+I visited the cultivated lands, [217] which I found planted with fine
+grain. The gardens contained all kinds of plants, cabbages, radishes,
+lettuce, purslain, sorrel, parsley, and other plants, squashes, cucumbers,
+melons, peas, beans and other vegetables, which were as fine and forward as
+in France. There were also the vines, which had been transplanted, already
+well advanced. In a word, you could see everything growing and flourishing.
+Aside from God, we are not to give the praise for this to the laborers or
+their skill, for it is probable that not much is due to them, but to the
+richness and excellence of the soil, which is naturally good and adapted
+for everything, as experience shows, and might be turned to good account,
+not only for purposes of tillage and the cultivation of fruit-trees and
+vines, but also for the nourishment and rearing of cattle and fowl, such as
+are common in France. But the thing lacking is zeal and affection for the
+welfare and service of the King.
+
+I tarried some time at Quebec, in expectation of further intelligence, when
+there arrived a barque from Tadoussac, which had been sent by Sieur du
+Pont Grave to get the men and merchandise remaining at that place on the
+before-mentioned large vessel. Leaving Quebec, I embarked with them for
+Trois Rivieres, where the trading was going on, in order to see the savages
+and communicate with them, and ascertain what was taking place respecting
+the assassination above set forth, and what could be done to settle and
+smooth over the whole matter.
+
+On the 5th of July following I set out from Quebec, together with Sieur de
+la Mothe, for Trois Rivieres, both for engaging in traffic and to see the
+savages. We arrived, at evening off Sainte Croix, [218] a place on the way
+so called. Here we saw a shallop coming straight to us, in which were some
+men from Sieurs du Pont Grave and des Chesnes, and also some clerks and
+agents of the merchants. They asked me to despatch at once this shallop to
+Quebec for some merchandise remaining there, saying that a large number of
+savages had come for the purpose of making war.
+
+This intelligence was very agreeable to us, and in order to satisfy them,
+on the morning of the next day I left my barque and went on board a shallop
+in order to go more speedily to the savages, while the other, which had
+come from Trois Rivieres, continued its course to Quebec. We made such
+progress by rowing that we arrived at the before-mentioned place on the 7th
+of July at 3 o'clock in the afternoon. Upon landing, all the savages with
+whom I had been intimate in their country recognized me. They were awaiting
+me with impatience, and came up to me very happy and delighted to see me
+again, one after the other embracing me with demonstrations of great joy, I
+also receiving them in the same manner. In this agreeable way was spent the
+evening and remainder of this day, and on the next day the savages held a
+council among themselves, to ascertain from me whether I would again assist
+them, as I had done in the past and as I had promised them, in their wars
+against their enemies, by whom they are cruelly harassed and tortured.
+
+Meanwhile on our part we took counsel together to determine what we should
+do in the matter of the murder of the two deceased, in order that justice
+might be done, and that they might be restrained from committing such an
+offence in future.
+
+In regard to the assistance urgently requested by the savages for making
+war against their enemies, I replied that my disposition had not changed
+nor my courage abated, but that what prevented me from assisting them was
+that on the previous year, when the occasion and opportunity presented,
+they failed me when the time came; because when they had promised to return
+with a good number of warriors they did not do so, which caused me to
+withdraw without accomplishing much. Yet I told them the matter should be
+taken into consideration, but that for the present it was proper to
+determine what should be done in regard to the assassination of the two
+unfortunate men, and that satisfaction must be had. Upon this they left
+their council in seeming anger and vexation about the matter, offering to
+kill the criminals, and proceed at once to their execution, if assent were
+given, and acknowledging freely among themselves the enormity of the
+affair.
+
+But we would not consent to this, postponing our assistance to another
+time, requiring them to return to us the next year with a good number of
+men. I assured them, moreover, that I would entreat the King to favor us
+with men, means, and supplies to assist them and enable them to enjoy the
+rest they longed for, and victory over their enemies. At this they were
+greatly pleased, and thus we separated, after they had held two or three
+meetings on the subject, costing us several hours of time. Two or three
+days after my arrival at this place they proceeded to make merry, dance,
+and celebrate many great banquets in view of the future war in which I was
+to assist them.
+
+Then I stated to Sieur du Pont Grave what I thought about this murder; that
+it was desirable to make a greater demand upon them; that at present the
+savages would dare not only to do the same thing again but what would be
+more injurious to us; that I considered them people who were governed by
+example; that they might accuse the French of being wanting in courage;
+that if we said no more about the matter they would infer that we were
+afraid of them: and that if we should let them go so easily they would grow
+more insolent, bold, and intolerable, and we should even thereby tempt them
+to undertake greater and more pernicious designs. Moreover I said that the
+other tribes of savages, who had or should get knowledge of this act, and
+that it had been unrevenged, or compromised by gifts and presents, as is
+their custom, would boast that killing a man is no great matter; since the
+French make so little account of seeing their companions killed by their
+neighbors, who drink, eat, and associate intimately with them, as may be
+seen.
+
+But, on the other hand, in consideration of the various circumstances;
+namely, that the savages do not exercise reason, that they are hard to
+approach, are easily estranged, and are very ready to take vengeance, that,
+if we should force them to inflict punishment, there would be no security
+for those desirous of making explorations among them, we determined to
+settle this affair in a friendly manner, and pass over quietly what had
+occurred, leaving them to engage peaceably in their traffic with the clerks
+and agents of the merchants and others in charge.
+
+Now there was with them a man named _Estienne Brule_, one of our
+interpreters, who had been living with them for eight years, as well to
+pass his time as to see the country and learn their language and mode of
+life. He is the one whom I had despatched with orders to go in the
+direction of the Entouhonorons, [219] to Carantouean, in order to bring with
+him five hundred warriors they had promised to send to assist us in the war
+in which we were engaged against their enemies, a reference to which is
+made in the narrative of my previous book. [220] I called this man, namely
+Estienne Brule, and asked him why he had not brought the assistance of the
+five hundred men, and what was the cause of the delay, and why he had not
+rendered me a report. Thereupon he gave me an account of the matter, a
+narrative of which it will not be out of place to give, as he is more to be
+pitied than blamed on account of the misfortunes which he experienced on
+this commission.
+
+He proceeded to say that, after taking leave of me to go on his journey and
+execute his commission, he set out with the twelve savages whom I had given
+him for the purpose of showing the way, and to serve as an escort on
+account of the dangers which he might have to encounter. They were
+successful in reaching the place, Carantouean, but not without exposing
+themselves to risk, since they had to pass through the territories of their
+enemies, and, in order to avoid any evil design, pursued a more secure
+route through thick and impenetrable forests, wood and brush, marshy bogs,
+frightful and unfrequented places and wastes, all to avoid danger and a
+meeting with their enemies.
+
+But, in spite of this great care, Brule and his savage companions, while
+crossing a plain, encountered some hostile savages, who were returning to
+their village and who were surprised and worsted by our savages, four of
+the enemy being killed on the spot and two taken prisoners, whom Brule and
+his companions took to Carantouean, by the inhabitants of which place they
+were received with great affection, a cordial welcome, and good cheer, with
+the dances and banquets with which they are accustomed to entertain and
+honor strangers.
+
+Some days were spent in this friendly reception; and, after Brule had told
+them his mission and explained to them the occasion of his journey, the
+savages of the place assembled in council to deliberate and resolve in
+regard to sending the five hundred warriors asked for by Brule.
+
+When the council was ended and it was decided to send the men, orders were
+given to collect, prepare, and arm them, so as to go and join us where we
+were encamped before the fort and village of our enemies. This was only
+three short days' journey from Carantouean, which was provided with more
+than eight hundred warriors, and strongly fortified, after the manner of
+those before described, which have high and strong palisades well bound and
+joined together, the quarters being constructed in a similar fashion.
+
+After it had been resolved by the inhabitants of Carantouean to send the
+five hundred men, these were very long in getting ready, although urged by
+Brule, to make haste, who explained to them that if they delayed any longer
+they would not find us there. And in fact they did not succeed in arriving
+until two days after our departure from that place, which we were forced to
+abandon, since we were too weak and worn by the inclemency of the weather.
+This caused Brule, and the five hundred men whom he brought, to withdraw
+and return to their village of Carantouean. After their return Brule was
+obliged to stay, and spend the rest of the autumn and all the winter, for
+lack of company and escort home. While awaiting, he busied himself in
+exploring the country and visiting the tribes and territories adjacent to
+that place, and in making a tour along a river [221] that debouches in the
+direction of Florida, where are many powerful and warlike nations, carrying
+on wars against each other. The climate there is very temperate, and there
+are great numbers of animals and abundance of small game. But to traverse
+and reach these regions requires patience, on account of the difficulties
+involved in passing the extensive wastes.
+
+He continued his course along the river as far as the sea, [222] and to
+islands and lands near them, which are inhabited by various tribes and
+large numbers of savages, who are well disposed and love the French above
+all other nations. But those who know the Dutch [223] complain severely of
+them, since they treat them very roughly. Among other things he observed
+that the winter was very temperate, that it snowed very rarely, and that
+when it did the snow was not a foot deep and melted immediately.
+
+After traversing the country and observing what was noteworthy, he returned
+to the village of Carantouean, in order to find an escort for returning to
+our settlement. After some stay at Carantouean, five or six of the savages
+decided to make the journey with Brule. On the way they encountered a large
+number of their enemies, who charged upon Brule and his companions so
+violently that they caused them to break up and separate from each other,
+so that they were unable to rally: and Brule, who had kept apart in the
+hope of escaping, became so detached from the others that he could not
+return, nor find a road or sign in order to effect his retreat in any
+direction whatever. Thus he continued to wander through forest and wood for
+several days without eating, and almost despairing of his life from the
+pressure of hunger. At last he came upon a little footpath, which he
+determined to follow wherever it might lead, whether toward the enemy or
+not, preferring to expose himself to their hands trusting in God rather
+than to die alone and in this wretched manner. Besides he knew how to speak
+their language, which he thought might afford him some assistance.
+
+But he had not gone a long distance when he discovered three savages loaded
+with fish repairing to their village. He ran after them, and, as he
+approached, shouted at them, as is their custom. At this they turned about,
+and filled with fear were about to leave their burden and flee. But Brule
+speaking to them reassured them, when they laid down their bows and arrows
+in sign of peace, Brule on his part laying down his arms. Moreover he was
+weak and feeble, not having eaten for three or four days. On coming up to
+them, after he had told them of his misfortune and the miserable condition
+to which he had been reduced, they smoked together, as they are accustomed
+to do with one another and their acquaintances when they visit each
+other. They had pity and compassion for him, offering him every assistance,
+and conducting him to their village, where they entertained him and gave
+him something to eat.
+
+But as soon as the people of the place were informed that an _Adoresetouey_
+had arrived, for thus they call the French, the name signifying _men of
+iron_, they came in a rush and in great numbers to see Brule. They took him
+to the cabin of one of the principal chiefs, where he was interrogated, and
+asked who he was, whence he came, what circumstance had driven and led him
+to this place, how he had lost his way, and whether he did not belong to
+the French nation that made war upon them. To this he replied that he
+belonged to a better nation, that was desirous solely of their acquaintance
+and friendship. Yet they would not believe this, but threw themselves upon
+him, tore out his nails with their teeth, burnt him with glowing
+firebrands, and tore out his beard, hair by hair, though contrary to the
+will of the chief.
+
+During this fit of passion one of the savages observed an _Agnus Dei_,
+which he had attached to his neck, and asked what it was that he had thus
+attached to his neck, and was on the point of seizing it and pulling it
+off. But Brule said to him, with resolute words, If you take it and put me
+to death, you will find that immediately after you will suddenly die, and
+all those of your house. He paid no attention however to this, but
+continuing in his malicious purpose tried to seize the _Agnus Dei_ and tear
+it from him, all of them together being desirous of putting him to death,
+but previously of making him suffer great pain and torture, such as they
+generally practise upon their enemies.
+
+But God, showing him mercy, was pleased not to allow it, but in his
+providence caused the heavens to change suddenly from the serene and fair
+state they were in to darkness, and to become filled with great and thick
+clouds, upon which followed thunders and lightnings so violent and long
+continued that it was something strange and awful. This storm caused the
+savages such terror, it being not only unusual but unlike anything they had
+ever heard, that their attention was diverted and they forgot the evil
+purpose they had towards Brule, their prisoner. They accordingly left him
+without even unbinding him, as they did not dare to approach him. This gave
+the sufferer an opportunity to use gentle words, and he appealed to them
+and remonstrated with them on the harm they were doing him without cause,
+and set forth to them how our God was enraged at them for having so abused
+him.
+
+The captain then approached Brule, unbound him, and took him to his house,
+where he took care of him and treated his wounds. After this there were no
+dances, banquets, or merry-makings to which Brule was not invited.
+
+So after remaining some time with these savages, he determined to proceed
+towards our settlement.
+
+Taking leave of them, he promised to restore them to harmony with the
+French and their enemies, and cause them to swear friendship with each
+other, to which end he said he would return to them as soon as he
+could. Thence he went to the country and village of the Atinouaentans,
+[224] where I had already been; the savages at his departure having
+conducted him for a distance of four days' journey from their village. Here
+Brule remained some time, when, resuming his journey towards us he came by
+way of the _Mer Douce_, [225] boating along its northern shores for some
+ten days, where I had also gone when on my way to the war.
+
+And if Brule had gone further on to explore these regions, as I had
+directed him to do, it would not have been a mere rumor that they were
+preparing war with one another. But this undertaking was reserved to
+another time, which he promised me to continue and accomplish in a short
+period with God's grace, and to conduct me there that I might obtain fuller
+and more particular knowledge.
+
+After he had made this recital, I gave him assurance that his services
+would be recognized, and encouraged him to continue his good purpose until
+our return, when we should have more abundant means to do that with which
+he would be satisfied. This is now the entire narrative and recital of his
+journey from the time he left me [226] to engage in the above-mentioned
+explorations; and it afforded me pleasure in the prospect thereby presented
+me of being better able to continue and promote them.
+
+With this purpose he took leave of me to return to the savages, an intimate
+acquaintance with whom had been acquired by him in his journeys and
+explorations. I begged him to continue with them until the next year, when
+I would return with a good number of men, both to reward him for his
+labors, and to assist as in the past the savages, his friends, in their
+wars.
+
+Resuming the thread of my former discourse, I must note that in my last and
+preceding voyages and explorations I had passed through numerous and
+diverse tribes of savages not known to the French nor to those of our
+settlement, with whom I had made alliances and sworn friendship, on
+condition that they should come and trade with us, and that I should assist
+them in their wars; for it must be understood that there is not a single
+tribe living in peace, excepting the Nation Neutre. According to their
+promise, there came from the various tribes of savages recently discovered
+some trade in peltry, others to see the French and ascertain what kind of
+treatment and welcome would be shown them. This encouraged everybody, the
+French on the one hand to show them cordiality and welcome, for they
+honored them with some attentions and presents, which the agents of the
+merchants gave to gratify them; on the other hand, it encouraged the
+savages, who promised all the French to come and live in future in
+friendship with them, all of them declaring that they would deport
+themselves with such affection towards us that we should have occasion to
+commend them, while we in like manner were to assist them to the extent of
+our power in their wars.
+
+The trading having been concluded, and the savages having taken their leave
+and departed, we left Trois Rivieres on the 14th of July of this year. The
+next day we arrived at our quarters at Quebec, where the barques were
+unloaded of the merchandise which had remained over from the traffic and
+which was put in the warehouse of the merchants at that place.
+
+Now Sieur de Pont Grave went to Tadoussac with the barques in order to load
+them and carry to the habitation the provisions necessary to support those
+who were to remain and winter there, and I determined while the barques
+were thus engaged to continue there for some days in order to have the
+necessary fortifications and repairs made.
+
+At my departure from the settlement I took leave of the holy Fathers, Sieur
+de la Mothe, and all the others who were to stay there, giving them to
+expect that I would return, God assisting, with a good number of families
+to people the country. I embarked on the 26th of July, together with the
+Fathers Paul and Pacifique, [227] the latter having wintered here once and
+the other having been here a year and a half, who were to make a report of
+what they had seen in the country and of what could be done there. We set
+out on the day above mentioned from the settlement for Tadoussac, where we
+were to embark for France. We arrived the next day and found our vessels
+ready to set sail. We embarked, and left Tadoussac for France on the 13th
+of the month of July, 1618, and arrived at Honfleur on the 28th day of
+August, the wind having been favorable, and all being in good spirits.
+
+ENDNOTES:
+
+201. Champlain made a voyage to New France in 1617, but appears to have
+ kept no journal of its events. He simply observes that nothing
+ occurred worthy of remark. _Vide_ issue of 1632, Quebec ed., p. 969.
+ Sagard gives a brief narrative of the events that occurred that
+ year. Vol. I. pp. 34-44.
+
+202. Eustache Boulle. His father was Nicolas Boulle, Secretary of the
+ King's Chamber, and his mother was Marguerite Alix. _Vide_ Vol. I.
+ p. 205 _et passim_.
+
+203. Nicolas de La Mothe, or de la Motte le Vilin. He had been Lieutenant
+ of Saussaye in 1613, when Capt. Argall captured the French colony at
+ Mount Desert. _Vide Les Voyages de Champlain_, 1632, Quebec ed.,
+ p. 773; _Relation de la Nouvelle France_, Pere Biard, p. 64.
+
+204. _Fauquets_. Probably the common Tern, or Sea Swallow. _Sterna
+ hirundo_. Peter Kalm, on his voyage in 1749, says "Terns, _sterna
+ hirundo, Linn_, though of a somewhat darker colour than the common
+ ones, we found after the forty-first degree of north latitude and
+ forty-seventh degree of west longitude from _London_, very
+ plentifully, and sometimes in flocks of some hundreds; sometimes they
+ settled, as if tired, on our ship." _Kalm's Travels_, 1770,
+ Vol. I. p. 23.
+
+205. St. John's day was June 24th.
+
+206. According to Sagard they were assassinated about the middle of April,
+ 1617. _Hist. Canada_, Vol. I. p. 42.
+
+207. Sagard says the French, on account of this affair, were menaced by
+ eight hundred savages of different nations who were assembled at Trois
+ Rivieres. _Vide Histoire du Canada_, 1636, Vol. I. p.42. The
+ statement, "on estoit menace de huict cens Sauvages de diuerse
+ nations, qui festoient assemblez es Trois Rivieres a dessein de venir
+ surprendre les Francois & leur coupper a tous la gorge, pour preuenir
+ la vengeance qu'ils eussent pu prendre de deux de leurs hommes tuez
+ par les Montagnais environ la my Auril de l'an 1617," is, we think,
+ too strong. The savages were excited and frightened by the demands of
+ the French, who desired to produce upon their minds a strong moral
+ impression, in order to prevent a recurrence of the murder, which was
+ a private thing, in which the great body of the savages had no part.
+ They could not be said to be hostile, though they prudently put
+ themselves in a state of defence, as, under the circumstances, it was
+ very natural they should do.
+
+208. They were then at Trois Rivieres.
+
+209. The moat around the habitation at Quebec was fifteen feet wide and six
+ feet deep, constructed with a drawbridge to be taken up in case of
+ need. _Vide_ Vol II p. 182.
+
+210. Probably Pere le Caron, who was in charge of the mission at Quebec at
+ that time.
+
+211. _Vide Histoire du Canada_, par Sagard, 1636, Vol. I. p 45.
+
+212. They arrived on St. John's day, _antea, note 205_, and consequently
+ this was the 2tth of June, 1618.
+
+213. Jean d'Olbeau.
+
+214. Frere Modeste Guines. _Vide Histoire du Canada_, par Sagard, a Paris,
+ 1636, Vol. I.p. 40.
+
+215. Joseph le Caron, Paul Huet, and Pacifique du Plessis.
+
+216. Louis Hebert, an apothecary, settled at Port Royal in La Cadie or Nova
+ Scotia, under Poutrincourt, was there when, in 1613, possession was
+ taken in the name of Madame de Guercheville. He afterward took up his
+ abode at Quebec with his family, probably in the year 1617. His eldest
+ daughter Anne was married at Quebec to Estienne Jonquest, a Norman,
+ which was the first marriage that took place with the ceremonies of
+ the Church in Canada. His daughter Guillemette married William
+ Couillard, and to her Champlain committed the two Indian girls, whom
+ he was not permitted by Kirke to take with him to France, when Quebec
+ was captured by the English in 1629. Louis Hebert died at Quebec on
+ the 25th of January, 1627. _Histoire du Canada_, Vol. I. pp. 41, 591.
+
+217. These fields were doubtless those of Louis Hebert, who was the first
+ that came into the country with his family to live by the cultivation
+ of the soil.
+
+218. Platon. _Vide_ Vol. 1., note 155.
+
+219. Champlain says, _donne charge d'aller vers les Entouhonorons a
+ Carantouan_. By reference to the map of 1632. it will be seen that the
+ Entouhonorons were situated on the southern borders of Lake Ontario.
+ They are understood by Champlain to be a part at least of the
+ Iroquois; but the Carantouanais, allies of the Hurons, were south of
+ them, occupying apparently the upper waters of the Susquehanna. A
+ dotted line will be seen on the same map, evidently intended to mark
+ the course of Brule's journey. From the meagre knowledge which
+ Champlain possessed of the region, the line can hardly be supposed to
+ be very accurate, which may account for Champlain's indefinite
+ expression as cited at the beginning of this note.
+
+ The Entouhonorons, Quentouoronons, Tsonnontouans, or Senecas
+ constituted the most western and most numerous canton of the Five
+ Nations. _Vide Continuation of the New Discovery_, by Louis Hennepin,
+ 1699, p. 95; also Origin of the name Seneca in Mr. O. H. Marshall's
+ brochure on _De la Salle among the Senecas_, pp. 43-45.
+
+220. _Vide antea_, p. 124.
+
+221. The River Susquehanna.
+
+222. He appears to have gone as far south at least as the upper waters of
+ Chesapeake Bay.
+
+223. The Dutch fur-traders. _Vide History of the State of New York_ by John
+ Romeyn Brodhead, Vol. I. p. 44 _et passim_.
+
+224. Attigonantans or Attignaouantans the principal tribe of the Hurons,
+ sometimes called _Les bons Iroquis_, as they and the Iroquois were of
+ the same original stock. _Vide_ Vol. I. p. 276, note 212.
+
+225. Lake Huron. For the different names which have been attached to this
+ lake, _vide Local Names of Niagara Frontier_, by Orsamus H. Marshall,
+ 1881, P. 37.
+
+226. Brule was despatched on his mission Sept 8, 1615. _Vide antea_,
+ p. 124.
+
+ As we have already stated in a previous note, it was the policy of
+ Champlain to place competent young men with the different tribes of
+ savages to obtain that kind of information which could only come from
+ an actual and prolonged residence with them. This enabled him to
+ secure not only the most accurate knowledge of their domestic habits
+ and customs, the character and spirit of their life, but these young
+ men by their long residence with the savages acquired a good knowledge
+ of their language, and were able to act as interpreters. This was a
+ matter of very great importance, as it was often necessary for
+ Champlain to communicate with the different tribes in making treaties
+ of friendship, in discussing questions of war with their enemies, in
+ settling disagreements among themselves, and in making arrangements
+ with them for the yearly purchase of their peltry. It was not easy to
+ obtain suitable persons for this important office. Those who had the
+ intellectual qualifications, and who had any high aspirations, would
+ not naturally incline to pass years in the stupid and degrading
+ associations, to say nothing of the hardships and deprivations, of
+ savage life. They were generally therefore adventurers, whose honesty
+ and fidelity had no better foundation than their selfish interests. Of
+ this sort was this Etienne Brule, as well as Nicholas Marsolet and
+ Pierre Raye, all of whom turned traitors, selling themselves to the
+ English when Quebec was taken in 1629. Of Brule, Champlain uses the
+ following emphatic language: "Le truchement Brusle a qui l'on donnoit
+ cent pistolles par an, pour inciter les sauuages a venir a la traitte,
+ ce qui estoit de tres-mauuais exemple, d'enuoyer ainsi des personnes
+ si maluiuans, que l'on eust deub chastier seuerement, car l'on
+ recognoissoit cet homme pour estre fort vicieux, & adonne aux femmes;
+ mais que ne fait faire l'esperance du gain, qui passe par dessus
+ toutes considerations." _Vide issue of_ 1632, Quebec ed., pp. 1065,
+ 1229.
+
+ But among Champlain's interpreters there were doubtless some who bore
+ a very different character. Jean Nicolet was certainly a marked
+ exception. Although Champlain does not mention him by name, he appears
+ to have been in New France as early as 1618, where he spent many years
+ among the Algonquins, and was the first Frenchman who penetrated the
+ distant Northwest. He married into one of the most respectable
+ families of Quebec, and is often mentioned in the Relations des
+ Jesuites. _Vide_ a brief notice of him in _Discovery and Exploration
+ of the Mississippi Valley_, by John Gilmary Shea, 1852, p. xx. A full
+ account of his career has recently been published, entitled _History
+ of the Discovery of the Northwest by John Nicolet in_ 1634, _with a
+ Sketch of his Life_. By C. W. Butterfield. Cincinnati, 1881. _Vide_
+ also _Details fur la Vie de Jean Nicollet_, an extract from _Relation
+ des Jesuites_, 1643, in _Decouveries_, etc, par Pierre Margry, p. 49.
+
+227. Paul Huet and Pacifique du Plessis. The latter had been in New France
+ more than a year and a half, having arrived in 1615. _Vide antea_,
+ pp. 104-5.
+
+
+
+
+EXPLANATION
+OF
+TWO GEOGRAPHICAL MAPS OF NEW FRANCE.
+
+
+It has seemed to me well to make some statements in explanation of the two
+geographical maps. Although one corresponds to the other so far as the
+harbors, bays, capes, promontories, and rivers extending into the interior
+are concerned, nevertheless they are different in respect to the bearings.
+
+The smallest is in its true meridian, in accordance with the directions of
+Sieur de Castelfranc in his book on the mecometry of the magnetic needle
+[228] where I have noted, as will be seen on the map, several declinations,
+which have been of much service to me, so also all the altitudes,
+latitudes, and longitudes, from the forty-first degree of latitude to the
+fifty-first, in the direction of the North Pole, which are the confines of
+Canada, or the Great Bay, where more especially the Basques and Spaniards
+engage in the whale fishery. In certain places in the great river
+St. Lawrence, in latitude 45 deg., I have observed the declination of the
+magnetic needle, and found it as high as twenty-one degrees, which is the
+greatest I have seen.
+
+The small map will serve very well for purposes of navigation, provided the
+needle be applied properly to the rose [229] indicating the points of the
+compass. For instance, in using it, when one is on the Grand Bank where
+fresh fishing is carried on, it is necessary, for the sake of greater
+convenience, to take a rose where the thirty-two points are marked equally,
+and put the point of the magnetic needle 12, 15, or 16 degrees from the
+_fleur de lis_ on the northwest side, which is nearly a point and a half,
+that is north a point northwest or a little more, from the fleur de lis of
+said rose, and then adjust the rose to the compass. By this means the
+latitudes of all the capes, harbors, and rivers can be accurately
+ascertained.
+
+I am aware that there are many who will not make use of it, but will prefer
+to run according to the large one, since it is made according to the
+compass of France, where the magnetic needle varies to the northeast, for
+the reason that they are so accustomed to this method that it is difficult
+for them to change. For this reason I have prepared the large map in this
+manner, for the assistance of the majority of the pilots and mariners in
+the waters of New France, fearing that if I had not done so, they would
+have ascribed to me a mistake, not knowing whence it proceeded. For the
+small plans or charts of Newfoundland are, for the most part, different in
+all their statements with respect to the positions of the lands and their
+latitudes. And those who may have some small copies, reasonably good,
+esteem them so valuable that they do not communicate a knowledge of them to
+their country, which might derive profit therefrom.
+
+Now the construction of these maps is such that they have their meridian in
+a direction north-northeast, making west west-northwest, which is contrary
+to the true meridian of this place, namely, to call north-northeast north,
+for the needle instead of varying to the northwest, as it should, varies to
+the northeast as if it were in France. The consequence of this is that
+error has resulted, and will continue to do so, since this antiquated
+custom is practised, which they still retain, although they fall into grave
+mistakes.
+
+They also make use of a compass marked north and south; that is, so that
+the point of the magnetic needle is directly on the _fleur de lis_. In
+accordance with such a compass many construct their small maps, which seems
+to me the better way, and so approach nearer to the true meridian of New
+France, than the compasses of France proper, which point to the
+northeast. It has come about, consequently, in this way that the first
+navigators who sailed to New France thought there was no greater deviation
+in going to these parts than to the Azores, or other places near France,
+where the deviation is almost imperceptible in navigation, the navigators
+having the compasses of France, which point northeast and represent the
+true meridian. In sailing constantly westward with the purpose of reaching
+a certain latitude, they laid their course directly west by their compass,
+supposing that they were sailing on the one parallel where they wished to
+go. By thus going constantly in a straight line and not in a circle, as all
+the parallels on the surface of the globe run, they found after having
+traversed a long distance, and as they were approaching the land, that they
+were some three, four, or five degrees farther south than they ought to be,
+thus being deceived in their true latitude and reckoning.
+
+It is true, indeed, that, when the weather was fair and the fun clearly
+visible, they corrected their latitude, but not without wondering how it
+happened that their course was wrong, which arose in consequence of their
+sailing in a straight instead of a circular line according to the parallel,
+so that in changing their meridian they changed with regard to the points
+of the compass, and consequently their course. It is, They therefore, very
+necessary to know the meridian, and the declination of the magnetic needle,
+for this knowledge can serve all navigators. This is especially so in the
+north and south, where there are greater variations in the magnetic needle,
+and where the meridians of longitude are smaller, so that the error, if the
+declination were not known, would be greater. This above-mentioned error
+has accordingly arisen, because navigators have either not cared to correct
+it, or did not know how to do so, and have left it in the state in which it
+now is. It is consequently difficult to abandon this manner of sailing in
+the regions of New France.
+
+This has led me to make this large map, not only that it might be more
+minute than the small one, but also in order to satisfy navigators, who
+will thus be able to sail as they do according to their small maps; and
+they will excuse me for not making it better and more in detail, for the
+life of a man is not long enough to observe things so exactly that at least
+something would not be found to have been omitted. Hence inquiring and
+pains-taking persons will, in sailing, observe things not to be found on
+this map, but which they add to it, so that in the courte of time there
+will be no doubt as to any of the localities indicated. At least it seems
+to me that I have done my duty, so far as I could, not having sailed to put
+on my map anything that I have seen, and thus giving to the public special
+knowledge of what had never been described, nor so carefully explored as I
+have done it. Although in the past others have written of these things,
+yet very little in comparison with what we have explored within the past
+ten years.
+
+
+MODE OF DETERMINING A MERIDIAN LINE.
+
+Take a small piece of board, perfectly level, and place in the middle a
+needle C, three inches high, so that it shall be exactly perpendicular.
+Expose it to the sun before noon, at 8 or 9 o'clock, and mark the point B
+at the end of the shadow cast by the needle. Then opening the compasses,
+with one point on C and the other on the shadow B, describe an arc AB.
+Leave the whole in this position until afternoon when you see the shadow
+just reaching the arc at A. Then divide equally the arc AB, and taking a
+rule, and placing it on the points C and D, draw a line running the whole
+length of the board, which is not to be moved until the observation is
+completed. This line will be the meridian of the place you are in.
+
+And in order to ascertain the declination of the place where you are with
+reference to the meridian, place a compass, which must be rectangular,
+along the meridian line, as shown in the figure above, there being upon the
+card a circle divided into 360 degrees. Divide the circle by two
+diametrical lines; one representing the north and south, as indicated by
+EF, the other the east and west, as indicated by GH. Then observe the
+magnetic needle turning on its pivot upon the card, and you will see how
+much it deviates from the fixed meridian line upon the card, and how many
+degrees it varies to the northeast of northwest.
+
+
+
+
+CHAMPLAIN'S LARGE MAP.
+
+GEOGRAPHICAL CHART OF NEW FRANCE, MADE BY SIEUR DE CHAMPLAIN OF SAINTONGE,
+CAPTAIN IN ORDINARY FOR THE KING IN THE MARINE. MADE IN THE YEAR 1612.
+
+I have made this map for the greater convenience of the majority of those
+who navigate on these coasts, since they sail to that country according to
+compasses arranged for the hemisphere of Asia. And if I had made it like
+the small one, the majority would not have been able to use it, owing to
+their not knowing the declinations of the needle. [230]
+
+Observe that on the present map north-northeast stands for north, and
+west-northwest for west; according to which one is to be guided in
+ascertaining the elevation of the degrees of latitude, as if these points
+were actually east and west, north and south, since the map is constructed
+according to the compasses of France, which vary to the northeast. [231]
+
+
+SOME DECLINATIONS OF THE MAGNETIC NEEDLE,
+WHICH I HAVE CAREFULLY OBSERVED.
+
+Cap Breton . . . . . . 14 deg. 50'
+Cap de la Have . . . . 16 deg. 15'
+Baye Ste Mane . . . . 17 deg. 16'
+Port Royal . . . . . . 17 deg. 8'
+En la grande R. St Laurent 21 deg.
+
+St Croix . . . . . . . 17 deg. 32'
+Riviere de Norumbegue. 18 deg. 40'
+Quinibequi . . . . . . 19 deg. 12'
+Mallebarre . . . . . . 18 deg. 40'
+
+All observed by Sieur de Champlain, 1612.
+
+REFERENCES ON CHAMPLAIN'S LARGE MAP.
+
+ A. Port Fortune.
+ B. Baye Blanche.
+ C. Baye aux Isles.
+ D. Cap des Isles.
+ E. Port aux Isles.
+ F. Isle Haute.
+ G. Isle des Monts Deserts.
+ H. Cap Corneille.
+ I. Isles aux Oiseaux.
+ K. Cap des Deux Bayes.
+ L. Port aux Mines
+ M. Cap Fourchu.
+ N. Cap Negre.
+ O. Port du Rossignol.
+ P. St. Laurent.
+ Q. Riviere de l'Isle Verte.
+ R. Baye Saine.
+ S. Riviere Sainte Marguerite
+ T. Port Sainte Helene.
+ V. Isle des Martires.
+ X. Isles Rangees.
+ Y. Port de Savalette.
+ Z. Passage du Glas.
+
+ 1. Port aux Anglois.
+ 2. Baye Courante.
+ 3. Cap de Poutrincourt.
+ 4. Isle Gravee.
+ 5. Passage Courant.
+ 6. Baye de Gennes.
+ 7. Isle Perdue.
+ 8. Cap des Mines.
+ 9. Port aux Coquilles.
+ 10. Isles Jumelles.
+ 11. Cap Saint Jean.
+ 12. Isle la Nef.
+ 13. La Heronniere Isle.
+ 14. Isles Rangees.
+ 15. Baye Saint Luc.
+ 16. Passage du Gas.
+ 17. Cote de Montmorency.
+ 18. Riviere de Champlain.
+ 19. Riviere Sainte Marie.
+ 20. Isle d'Orleans.
+ 21. Isle de Bacchus.
+
+NOTE--The reader will observe that in a few instances the references are
+wanting on the map.
+
+CHAMPLAIN'S NOTE TO THE SMALL MAP.
+
+On the small map [232] is added the strait above Labrador between the
+fifty-third and sixty-third degrees of latitude, which the English have
+discovered during the present year 1612, in their voyage to find, if
+possible, a passage to China by way of the north. [233] They wintered at a
+place indicated by this mark, 6. But it was not without enduring severe
+cold, and they were obliged to return to England, leaving their leader in
+the northern regions. Within fix months three other vessels have set out,
+to penetrate, if possible, still farther, and, at the same time, to search
+for the men who were left in that region.
+
+
+GEOGRAPHICAL MAP OF NEW FRANCE, IN ITS TRUE
+MERIDIAN.
+
+_Made by Sieur Champlain, Captain for the King in the Marine. 1613_.
+
+ +o Matou-ouescariny. [Note: This figure is inverted on the map. _Vide
+ antea_, note 59, p. 62.]
+ o+ Gaspay.
+ oo Ouescariny. [Note: _Vide antea_, note 47, pp. 59, 81. The figure oo is
+ misplaced and should be where o-o is on the map, on the extreme
+ western border near the forty-seventh degree of north latitude.]
+ o-o Quenongebin. [Note: This figure o-o on the map occupies the place
+ which should be occupied by oo. _Vide antea_, p. 58, note 46.]
+ A. Tadoussac.
+ B. Lesquemain.
+ C. Isle Percee.
+ D. Baye de Chaleur.
+ E. Isles aux Gros Yeux. [Note: A cluster of islands of which the Island
+ of Birds is one.]
+ H. Baye Francoise.
+ I. Isles aux Oyseaux.
+ L. Riviere des Etechemins. [Note: This letter, placed between the River
+ St. John and the St. Croix, refers to the latter.]
+ M. Menane.
+ N. Port Royal.
+ P. Isle Longue.
+ Q. Cap Fourchu.
+ R. Port au Mouton.
+ S. Port du Rossignol. [Note: The letter S appears twice on the coast of
+ La Cadie. The one here referred to is the more westerly.]
+ SS. Lac de Medicis. [Note: This reference is probably to the Lake of Two
+ Mountains, which will be seen on the map west of Montreal.]
+ T. Sesambre.
+ V. Cap des Deux Bayes.
+ 3. L'Isle aux Coudres.
+ 4. Saincte Croix. [Note: St. Croix on the map is where a cross surmounted
+ by the figure 4 may be seen.]
+ 4. Riviere des Etechemins. [Note: This appears to refer to the
+ Chaudiere. _Vide_ vol. I. p. 296.]
+ 5. Sault. [Note: This refers to the Falls of Montmorency.]
+ 6. Lac Sainct Pierre.
+ 7. Riviere des Yroquois.
+ 9. Isle aux Lieures.
+ 10. Riviere Platte. [Note: A small river flowing into Mal Bay. _Vide_
+ Vol. I. p. 295; also _Les Voyages de Champlain_, Quebec ed., p. 1099.]
+ 11. Mantane. [Note: _Vide_ Vol. I. p 234.]
+ 40. Cap Saincte Marie. [Note: The figures are wanting. Cape St. Mary is on
+ the southern coast of Newfoundland. _Vide_ Vol I. p. 232.]
+
+
+ENDNOTES:
+
+228. The determination of longitudes has from the beginning been environed
+ with almost insuperable difficulties. At one period the declination of
+ the magnetic needle was supposed to furnish the means of a practical
+ solution. Sebastian Cabot devoted considerable attention to the
+ subject, as did likewise Peter Plancius at a later date. Champlain
+ appears to have fixed the longitudes on his smaller map by
+ calculations based on the variation of the needle, guided by the
+ principles laid down by Guillaume de Nautonier, Sieur de Castelfranc,
+ to whose work he refers in the text. It was entitled, _Mecometrie de
+ l'eymant c'est a dire la maniere de mesurer les longitudes par le
+ moyen de l'eymant_. This rare volume is not to be found as far as my
+ inquiries extend, in any of the incorporated libraries on this
+ continent. There is however a copy in the Bodleian Library at Oxford,
+ to which in the catalogue is given the bibliographical note: _Six
+ livres. Folio. Tolose, 1603_.
+
+ It is hardly necessary to add that the forces governing the variation
+ of the needle, both local and general, are so inconstant that the hope
+ of fixing longitudes by it was long since abandoned.
+
+ The reason for the introduction of the explanation of the maps at this
+ place will be seen _antea_, p. 39.
+
+229. The rose is the face or card of the mariner's compass. It was
+ anciently called the fly. Card may perhaps be derived from the Italian
+ cardo, a thistle, which the face of the compass may be supposed to
+ resemble. On the complete circle of the compass there are thirty-two
+ lines drawn from the centre to the circumference to indicate the
+ direction of the wind. Each quarter of the circle, or 90 deg., contains
+ eight lines representing the points of the compass in that quarter.
+ They are named with reference to the cardinal points from which they
+ begin, as: 1, north, 2, north by east, 3, north-northeast; 4,
+ northeast by north; 5, northeast; 6, northeast by east; 7, east-
+ northeast; 8, east by north. The points in each quarter are named in a
+ similar manner.
+
+230. The above title is on the large map of 1612. This note is on the upper
+ left-hand corner of the same map.
+
+231. For this note see the upper right-hand corner of the map.
+
+232. In Champlain's issue in 1613, the note here given was placed in the
+ preliminary matter to that volume. It was placed there probably after
+ the rest of the work had gone to press. We have placed it here in
+ connection with other matter relating to the maps, where it seems more
+ properly to belong.
+
+233. This refers to the fourth voyage of Henry Hudson, made in 1610, for
+ the purpose here indicated. He penetrated Lomley's Inlet, hoping to
+ find a passage through to the Pacific Ocean, or, as it was then
+ called, the South Sea, and thus find a direct and shorter course to
+ China. He passed the winter at about 52 deg. north latitude, in that
+ expanse of water which has ever since been appropriately known ass
+ Hudson's Bay. A mutiny having broken out among his crew, he and eight
+ others having been forced into a small boat, on the 21st of June,
+ 1611, were set adrift on the sea, and were never heard of afterward.
+
+ A part of the mutinous crew arrived with the ship in England, and were
+ immediately thrown into prison. The following year, 1612, an
+ expedition under Sir Thomas Button was sent out to seek for Hudson,
+ and to prosecute the search still further for a northwest passage It
+ is needless to add that the search was unsuccessful.
+
+ A chart by Hudson fortunately escaped destruction by the mutineers.
+ Singularly enough, an engraving of it, entitled, TABVLA NAVTICA, was
+ published by Heffel Gerritz at Amsterdam the same year. Champlain
+ incorporated the part of it illustrating Hudson's discovery in his
+ smaller map, which is dated the fame year, 1612. He does not introduce
+ it into his large map, although that is dated likewise 1612. A
+ facsimile of the Tabula Nautica is given in Henry Hudson the
+ Navigator, by G. M. Asher, LL.D. published by the Hakluyt Society in
+ 1860.
+
+
+
+
+
+End of the Project Gutenberg EBook of Voyages of Samuel de Champlain V3
+by Samuel de Champlain
+
+*** END OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK VOYAGES OF SAMUEL DE CHAMPLAIN V3 ***
+
+This file should be named 7vcv310.txt or 7vcv310.zip
+Corrected EDITIONS of our eBooks get a new NUMBER, 7vcv311.txt
+VERSIONS based on separate sources get new LETTER, 7vcv310a.txt
+
+Produced by Karl Hagen, Juliet Sutherland, Charles Franks,
+and the Online Distributed Proofreading Team.
+This file was produced from images generously made available by
+the Canadian Institute for Historical Microreproductions.
+
+Project Gutenberg eBooks are often created from several printed
+editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the US
+unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we usually do not
+keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition.
+
+We are now trying to release all our eBooks one year in advance
+of the official release dates, leaving time for better editing.
+Please be encouraged to tell us about any error or corrections,
+even years after the official publication date.
+
+Please note neither this listing nor its contents are final til
+midnight of the last day of the month of any such announcement.
+The official release date of all Project Gutenberg eBooks is at
+Midnight, Central Time, of the last day of the stated month. A
+preliminary version may often be posted for suggestion, comment
+and editing by those who wish to do so.
+
+Most people start at our Web sites at:
+http://gutenberg.net or
+http://promo.net/pg
+
+These Web sites include award-winning information about Project
+Gutenberg, including how to donate, how to help produce our new
+eBooks, and how to subscribe to our email newsletter (free!).
+
+
+Those of you who want to download any eBook before announcement
+can get to them as follows, and just download by date. This is
+also a good way to get them instantly upon announcement, as the
+indexes our cataloguers produce obviously take a while after an
+announcement goes out in the Project Gutenberg Newsletter.
+
+http://www.ibiblio.org/gutenberg/etext03 or
+ftp://ftp.ibiblio.org/pub/docs/books/gutenberg/etext03
+
+Or /etext02, 01, 00, 99, 98, 97, 96, 95, 94, 93, 92, 92, 91 or 90
+
+Just search by the first five letters of the filename you want,
+as it appears in our Newsletters.
+
+
+Information about Project Gutenberg (one page)
+
+We produce about two million dollars for each hour we work. The
+time it takes us, a rather conservative estimate, is fifty hours
+to get any eBook selected, entered, proofread, edited, copyright
+searched and analyzed, the copyright letters written, etc. Our
+projected audience is one hundred million readers. If the value
+per text is nominally estimated at one dollar then we produce $2
+million dollars per hour in 2002 as we release over 100 new text
+files per month: 1240 more eBooks in 2001 for a total of 4000+
+We are already on our way to trying for 2000 more eBooks in 2002
+If they reach just 1-2% of the world's population then the total
+will reach over half a trillion eBooks given away by year's end.
+
+The Goal of Project Gutenberg is to Give Away 1 Trillion eBooks!
+This is ten thousand titles each to one hundred million readers,
+which is only about 4% of the present number of computer users.
+
+Here is the briefest record of our progress (* means estimated):
+
+eBooks Year Month
+
+ 1 1971 July
+ 10 1991 January
+ 100 1994 January
+ 1000 1997 August
+ 1500 1998 October
+ 2000 1999 December
+ 2500 2000 December
+ 3000 2001 November
+ 4000 2001 October/November
+ 6000 2002 December*
+ 9000 2003 November*
+10000 2004 January*
+
+
+The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation has been created
+to secure a future for Project Gutenberg into the next millennium.
+
+We need your donations more than ever!
+
+As of February, 2002, contributions are being solicited from people
+and organizations in: Alabama, Alaska, Arkansas, Connecticut,
+Delaware, District of Columbia, Florida, Georgia, Hawaii, Illinois,
+Indiana, Iowa, Kansas, Kentucky, Louisiana, Maine, Massachusetts,
+Michigan, Mississippi, Missouri, Montana, Nebraska, Nevada, New
+Hampshire, New Jersey, New Mexico, New York, North Carolina, Ohio,
+Oklahoma, Oregon, Pennsylvania, Rhode Island, South Carolina, South
+Dakota, Tennessee, Texas, Utah, Vermont, Virginia, Washington, West
+Virginia, Wisconsin, and Wyoming.
+
+We have filed in all 50 states now, but these are the only ones
+that have responded.
+
+As the requirements for other states are met, additions to this list
+will be made and fund raising will begin in the additional states.
+Please feel free to ask to check the status of your state.
+
+In answer to various questions we have received on this:
+
+We are constantly working on finishing the paperwork to legally
+request donations in all 50 states. If your state is not listed and
+you would like to know if we have added it since the list you have,
+just ask.
+
+While we cannot solicit donations from people in states where we are
+not yet registered, we know of no prohibition against accepting
+donations from donors in these states who approach us with an offer to
+donate.
+
+International donations are accepted, but we don't know ANYTHING about
+how to make them tax-deductible, or even if they CAN be made
+deductible, and don't have the staff to handle it even if there are
+ways.
+
+Donations by check or money order may be sent to:
+
+Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
+PMB 113
+1739 University Ave.
+Oxford, MS 38655-4109
+
+Contact us if you want to arrange for a wire transfer or payment
+method other than by check or money order.
+
+The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation has been approved by
+the US Internal Revenue Service as a 501(c)(3) organization with EIN
+[Employee Identification Number] 64-622154. Donations are
+tax-deductible to the maximum extent permitted by law. As fund-raising
+requirements for other states are met, additions to this list will be
+made and fund-raising will begin in the additional states.
+
+We need your donations more than ever!
+
+You can get up to date donation information online at:
+
+http://www.gutenberg.net/donation.html
+
+
+***
+
+If you can't reach Project Gutenberg,
+you can always email directly to:
+
+Michael S. Hart <hart@pobox.com>
+
+Prof. Hart will answer or forward your message.
+
+We would prefer to send you information by email.
+
+
+**The Legal Small Print**
+
+
+(Three Pages)
+
+***START**THE SMALL PRINT!**FOR PUBLIC DOMAIN EBOOKS**START***
+Why is this "Small Print!" statement here? You know: lawyers.
+They tell us you might sue us if there is something wrong with
+your copy of this eBook, even if you got it for free from
+someone other than us, and even if what's wrong is not our
+fault. So, among other things, this "Small Print!" statement
+disclaims most of our liability to you. It also tells you how
+you may distribute copies of this eBook if you want to.
+
+*BEFORE!* YOU USE OR READ THIS EBOOK
+By using or reading any part of this PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm
+eBook, you indicate that you understand, agree to and accept
+this "Small Print!" statement. If you do not, you can receive
+a refund of the money (if any) you paid for this eBook by
+sending a request within 30 days of receiving it to the person
+you got it from. If you received this eBook on a physical
+medium (such as a disk), you must return it with your request.
+
+ABOUT PROJECT GUTENBERG-TM EBOOKS
+This PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm eBook, like most PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm eBooks,
+is a "public domain" work distributed by Professor Michael S. Hart
+through the Project Gutenberg Association (the "Project").
+Among other things, this means that no one owns a United States copyright
+on or for this work, so the Project (and you!) can copy and
+distribute it in the United States without permission and
+without paying copyright royalties. Special rules, set forth
+below, apply if you wish to copy and distribute this eBook
+under the "PROJECT GUTENBERG" trademark.
+
+Please do not use the "PROJECT GUTENBERG" trademark to market
+any commercial products without permission.
+
+To create these eBooks, the Project expends considerable
+efforts to identify, transcribe and proofread public domain
+works. Despite these efforts, the Project's eBooks and any
+medium they may be on may contain "Defects". Among other
+things, Defects may take the form of incomplete, inaccurate or
+corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other
+intellectual property infringement, a defective or damaged
+disk or other eBook medium, a computer virus, or computer
+codes that damage or cannot be read by your equipment.
+
+LIMITED WARRANTY; DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES
+But for the "Right of Replacement or Refund" described below,
+[1] Michael Hart and the Foundation (and any other party you may
+receive this eBook from as a PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm eBook) disclaims
+all liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including
+legal fees, and [2] YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE OR
+UNDER STRICT LIABILITY, OR FOR BREACH OF WARRANTY OR CONTRACT,
+INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE
+OR INCIDENTAL DAMAGES, EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE
+POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.
+
+If you discover a Defect in this eBook within 90 days of
+receiving it, you can receive a refund of the money (if any)
+you paid for it by sending an explanatory note within that
+time to the person you received it from. If you received it
+on a physical medium, you must return it with your note, and
+such person may choose to alternatively give you a replacement
+copy. If you received it electronically, such person may
+choose to alternatively give you a second opportunity to
+receive it electronically.
+
+THIS EBOOK IS OTHERWISE PROVIDED TO YOU "AS-IS". NO OTHER
+WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, ARE MADE TO YOU AS
+TO THE EBOOK OR ANY MEDIUM IT MAY BE ON, INCLUDING BUT NOT
+LIMITED TO WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A
+PARTICULAR PURPOSE.
+
+Some states do not allow disclaimers of implied warranties or
+the exclusion or limitation of consequential damages, so the
+above disclaimers and exclusions may not apply to you, and you
+may have other legal rights.
+
+INDEMNITY
+You will indemnify and hold Michael Hart, the Foundation,
+and its trustees and agents, and any volunteers associated
+with the production and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm
+texts harmless, from all liability, cost and expense, including
+legal fees, that arise directly or indirectly from any of the
+following that you do or cause: [1] distribution of this eBook,
+[2] alteration, modification, or addition to the eBook,
+or [3] any Defect.
+
+DISTRIBUTION UNDER "PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm"
+You may distribute copies of this eBook electronically, or by
+disk, book or any other medium if you either delete this
+"Small Print!" and all other references to Project Gutenberg,
+or:
+
+[1] Only give exact copies of it. Among other things, this
+ requires that you do not remove, alter or modify the
+ eBook or this "small print!" statement. You may however,
+ if you wish, distribute this eBook in machine readable
+ binary, compressed, mark-up, or proprietary form,
+ including any form resulting from conversion by word
+ processing or hypertext software, but only so long as
+ *EITHER*:
+
+ [*] The eBook, when displayed, is clearly readable, and
+ does *not* contain characters other than those
+ intended by the author of the work, although tilde
+ (~), asterisk (*) and underline (_) characters may
+ be used to convey punctuation intended by the
+ author, and additional characters may be used to
+ indicate hypertext links; OR
+
+ [*] The eBook may be readily converted by the reader at
+ no expense into plain ASCII, EBCDIC or equivalent
+ form by the program that displays the eBook (as is
+ the case, for instance, with most word processors);
+ OR
+
+ [*] You provide, or agree to also provide on request at
+ no additional cost, fee or expense, a copy of the
+ eBook in its original plain ASCII form (or in EBCDIC
+ or other equivalent proprietary form).
+
+[2] Honor the eBook refund and replacement provisions of this
+ "Small Print!" statement.
+
+[3] Pay a trademark license fee to the Foundation of 20% of the
+ gross profits you derive calculated using the method you
+ already use to calculate your applicable taxes. If you
+ don't derive profits, no royalty is due. Royalties are
+ payable to "Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation"
+ the 60 days following each date you prepare (or were
+ legally required to prepare) your annual (or equivalent
+ periodic) tax return. Please contact us beforehand to
+ let us know your plans and to work out the details.
+
+WHAT IF YOU *WANT* TO SEND MONEY EVEN IF YOU DON'T HAVE TO?
+Project Gutenberg is dedicated to increasing the number of
+public domain and licensed works that can be freely distributed
+in machine readable form.
+
+The Project gratefully accepts contributions of money, time,
+public domain materials, or royalty free copyright licenses.
+Money should be paid to the:
+"Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation."
+
+If you are interested in contributing scanning equipment or
+software or other items, please contact Michael Hart at:
+hart@pobox.com
+
+[Portions of this eBook's header and trailer may be reprinted only
+when distributed free of all fees. Copyright (C) 2001, 2002 by
+Michael S. Hart. Project Gutenberg is a TradeMark and may not be
+used in any sales of Project Gutenberg eBooks or other materials be
+they hardware or software or any other related product without
+express permission.]
+
+*END THE SMALL PRINT! FOR PUBLIC DOMAIN EBOOKS*Ver.02/11/02*END*
+